xref: /linux/include/net/mac80211.h (revision 8be4d31cb8aaeea27bde4b7ddb26e28a89062ebf)
1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */
2 /*
3  * mac80211 <-> driver interface
4  *
5  * Copyright 2002-2005, Devicescape Software, Inc.
6  * Copyright 2006-2007	Jiri Benc <jbenc@suse.cz>
7  * Copyright 2007-2010	Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
8  * Copyright 2013-2014  Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
9  * Copyright (C) 2015 - 2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH
10  * Copyright (C) 2018 - 2025 Intel Corporation
11  */
12 
13 #ifndef MAC80211_H
14 #define MAC80211_H
15 
16 #include <linux/bug.h>
17 #include <linux/kernel.h>
18 #include <linux/if_ether.h>
19 #include <linux/skbuff.h>
20 #include <linux/ieee80211.h>
21 #include <linux/lockdep.h>
22 #include <net/cfg80211.h>
23 #include <net/codel.h>
24 #include <net/ieee80211_radiotap.h>
25 #include <linux/unaligned.h>
26 
27 /**
28  * DOC: Introduction
29  *
30  * mac80211 is the Linux stack for 802.11 hardware that implements
31  * only partial functionality in hard- or firmware. This document
32  * defines the interface between mac80211 and low-level hardware
33  * drivers.
34  */
35 
36 /**
37  * DOC: Calling mac80211 from interrupts
38  *
39  * Only ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() can be
40  * called in hardware interrupt context. The low-level driver must not call any
41  * other functions in hardware interrupt context. If there is a need for such
42  * call, the low-level driver should first ACK the interrupt and perform the
43  * IEEE 802.11 code call after this, e.g. from a scheduled workqueue or even
44  * tasklet function.
45  *
46  * NOTE: If the driver opts to use the _irqsafe() functions, it may not also
47  *	 use the non-IRQ-safe functions!
48  */
49 
50 /**
51  * DOC: Warning
52  *
53  * If you're reading this document and not the header file itself, it will
54  * be incomplete because not all documentation has been converted yet.
55  */
56 
57 /**
58  * DOC: Frame format
59  *
60  * As a general rule, when frames are passed between mac80211 and the driver,
61  * they start with the IEEE 802.11 header and include the same octets that are
62  * sent over the air except for the FCS which should be calculated by the
63  * hardware.
64  *
65  * There are, however, various exceptions to this rule for advanced features:
66  *
67  * The first exception is for hardware encryption and decryption offload
68  * where the IV/ICV may or may not be generated in hardware.
69  *
70  * Secondly, when the hardware handles fragmentation, the frame handed to
71  * the driver from mac80211 is the MSDU, not the MPDU.
72  */
73 
74 /**
75  * DOC: mac80211 workqueue
76  *
77  * mac80211 provides its own workqueue for drivers and internal mac80211 use.
78  * The workqueue is a single threaded workqueue and can only be accessed by
79  * helpers for sanity checking. Drivers must ensure all work added onto the
80  * mac80211 workqueue should be cancelled on the driver stop() callback.
81  *
82  * mac80211 will flush the workqueue upon interface removal and during
83  * suspend.
84  *
85  * All work performed on the mac80211 workqueue must not acquire the RTNL lock.
86  *
87  */
88 
89 /**
90  * DOC: mac80211 software tx queueing
91  *
92  * mac80211 uses an intermediate queueing implementation, designed to allow the
93  * driver to keep hardware queues short and to provide some fairness between
94  * different stations/interfaces.
95  *
96  * Drivers must provide the .wake_tx_queue driver operation by either
97  * linking it to ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() or implementing a custom
98  * handler.
99  *
100  * Intermediate queues (struct ieee80211_txq) are kept per-sta per-tid, with
101  * another per-sta for non-data/non-mgmt and bufferable management frames, and
102  * a single per-vif queue for multicast data frames.
103  *
104  * The driver is expected to initialize its private per-queue data for stations
105  * and interfaces in the .add_interface and .sta_add ops.
106  *
107  * The driver can't access the internal TX queues (iTXQs) directly.
108  * Whenever mac80211 adds a new frame to a queue, it calls the .wake_tx_queue
109  * driver op.
110  * Drivers implementing a custom .wake_tx_queue op can get them by calling
111  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue(). Drivers using ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() will
112  * simply get the individual frames pushed via the .tx driver operation.
113  *
114  * Drivers can optionally delegate responsibility for scheduling queues to
115  * mac80211, to take advantage of airtime fairness accounting. In this case, to
116  * obtain the next queue to pull frames from, the driver calls
117  * ieee80211_next_txq(). The driver is then expected to return the txq using
118  * ieee80211_return_txq().
119  *
120  * For AP powersave TIM handling, the driver only needs to indicate if it has
121  * buffered packets in the driver specific data structures by calling
122  * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(). For frames buffered in the ieee80211_txq
123  * struct, mac80211 sets the appropriate TIM PVB bits and calls
124  * .release_buffered_frames().
125  * In that callback the driver is therefore expected to release its own
126  * buffered frames and afterwards also frames from the ieee80211_txq (obtained
127  * via the usual ieee80211_tx_dequeue).
128  */
129 
130 /**
131  * DOC: HW timestamping
132  *
133  * Timing Measurement and Fine Timing Measurement require accurate timestamps
134  * of the action frames TX/RX and their respective acks.
135  *
136  * To report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine Timing
137  * Measurement frame RX, the low level driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp
138  * field to the frame RX timestamp and report the ack TX timestamp in the
139  * ieee80211_rx_status struct.
140  *
141  * Similarly, to report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine
142  * Timing Measurement frame TX, the driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp field
143  * to the frame TX timestamp and report the ack RX timestamp in the
144  * ieee80211_tx_status struct.
145  */
146 struct device;
147 
148 /**
149  * enum ieee80211_max_queues - maximum number of queues
150  *
151  * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES: Maximum number of regular device queues.
152  * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP: bitmap with maximum queues set
153  */
154 enum ieee80211_max_queues {
155 	IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES =		16,
156 	IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP =	BIT(IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES) - 1,
157 };
158 
159 #define IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE	0xff
160 
161 /**
162  * enum ieee80211_ac_numbers - AC numbers as used in mac80211
163  * @IEEE80211_AC_VO: voice
164  * @IEEE80211_AC_VI: video
165  * @IEEE80211_AC_BE: best effort
166  * @IEEE80211_AC_BK: background
167  */
168 enum ieee80211_ac_numbers {
169 	IEEE80211_AC_VO		= 0,
170 	IEEE80211_AC_VI		= 1,
171 	IEEE80211_AC_BE		= 2,
172 	IEEE80211_AC_BK		= 3,
173 };
174 
175 /**
176  * struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params - transmit queue configuration
177  *
178  * The information provided in this structure is required for QoS
179  * transmit queue configuration. Cf. IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.29.
180  *
181  * @aifs: arbitration interframe space [0..255]
182  * @cw_min: minimum contention window [a value of the form
183  *	2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
184  * @cw_max: maximum contention window [like @cw_min]
185  * @txop: maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
186  * @acm: is mandatory admission control required for the access category
187  * @uapsd: is U-APSD mode enabled for the queue
188  * @mu_edca: is the MU EDCA configured
189  * @mu_edca_param_rec: MU EDCA Parameter Record for HE
190  */
191 struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params {
192 	u16 txop;
193 	u16 cw_min;
194 	u16 cw_max;
195 	u8 aifs;
196 	bool acm;
197 	bool uapsd;
198 	bool mu_edca;
199 	struct ieee80211_he_mu_edca_param_ac_rec mu_edca_param_rec;
200 };
201 
202 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats {
203 	unsigned int dot11ACKFailureCount;
204 	unsigned int dot11RTSFailureCount;
205 	unsigned int dot11FCSErrorCount;
206 	unsigned int dot11RTSSuccessCount;
207 };
208 
209 /**
210  * enum ieee80211_chanctx_change - change flag for channel context
211  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH: The channel width changed
212  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS: The number of RX chains changed
213  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR: radar detection flag changed
214  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL: switched to another operating channel,
215  *	this is used only with channel switching with CSA
216  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_DEF: The min chandef changed
217  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_AP: The AP channel definition changed, so (wider
218  *	bandwidth) OFDMA settings need to be changed
219  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_PUNCTURING: The punctured channel(s) bitmap
220  *	was changed.
221  */
222 enum ieee80211_chanctx_change {
223 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH		= BIT(0),
224 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS	= BIT(1),
225 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR		= BIT(2),
226 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL	= BIT(3),
227 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_DEF	= BIT(4),
228 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_AP		= BIT(5),
229 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_PUNCTURING	= BIT(6),
230 };
231 
232 /**
233  * struct ieee80211_chan_req - A channel "request"
234  * @oper: channel definition to use for operation
235  * @ap: the channel definition of the AP, if any
236  *	(otherwise the chan member is %NULL)
237  */
238 struct ieee80211_chan_req {
239 	struct cfg80211_chan_def oper;
240 	struct cfg80211_chan_def ap;
241 };
242 
243 /**
244  * struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf - channel context that vifs may be tuned to
245  *
246  * This is the driver-visible part. The ieee80211_chanctx
247  * that contains it is visible in mac80211 only.
248  *
249  * @def: the channel definition
250  * @min_def: the minimum channel definition currently required.
251  * @ap: the channel definition the AP actually is operating as,
252  *	for use with (wider bandwidth) OFDMA
253  * @radio_idx: index of the wiphy radio used used for this channel
254  * @rx_chains_static: The number of RX chains that must always be
255  *	active on the channel to receive MIMO transmissions
256  * @rx_chains_dynamic: The number of RX chains that must be enabled
257  *	after RTS/CTS handshake to receive SMPS MIMO transmissions;
258  *	this will always be >= @rx_chains_static.
259  * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled on this channel.
260  * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
261  *	sizeof(void *), size is determined in hw information.
262  */
263 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf {
264 	struct cfg80211_chan_def def;
265 	struct cfg80211_chan_def min_def;
266 	struct cfg80211_chan_def ap;
267 
268 	int radio_idx;
269 	u8 rx_chains_static, rx_chains_dynamic;
270 
271 	bool radar_enabled;
272 
273 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
274 };
275 
276 /**
277  * enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode - channel context switch mode
278  * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF: Both old and new contexts already
279  *	exist (and will continue to exist), but the virtual interface
280  *	needs to be switched from one to the other.
281  * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS: The old context exists but will stop
282  *      to exist with this call, the new context doesn't exist but
283  *      will be active after this call, the virtual interface switches
284  *      from the old to the new (note that the driver may of course
285  *      implement this as an on-the-fly chandef switch of the existing
286  *      hardware context, but the mac80211 pointer for the old context
287  *      will cease to exist and only the new one will later be used
288  *      for changes/removal.)
289  */
290 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode {
291 	CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF,
292 	CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS,
293 };
294 
295 /**
296  * struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch - vif chanctx switch information
297  *
298  * This is structure is used to pass information about a vif that
299  * needs to switch from one chanctx to another.  The
300  * &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode defines how the switch should be
301  * done.
302  *
303  * @vif: the vif that should be switched from old_ctx to new_ctx
304  * @link_conf: the link conf that's switching
305  * @old_ctx: the old context to which the vif was assigned
306  * @new_ctx: the new context to which the vif must be assigned
307  */
308 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch {
309 	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
310 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf;
311 	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *old_ctx;
312 	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *new_ctx;
313 };
314 
315 /**
316  * enum ieee80211_bss_change - BSS change notification flags
317  *
318  * These flags are used with the bss_info_changed(), link_info_changed()
319  * and vif_cfg_changed() callbacks to indicate which parameter(s) changed.
320  *
321  * @BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC: association status changed (associated/disassociated),
322  *	also implies a change in the AID.
323  * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT: CTS protection changed
324  * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE: preamble changed
325  * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT: slot timing changed
326  * @BSS_CHANGED_HT: 802.11n parameters changed
327  * @BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES: Basic rateset changed
328  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT: Beacon interval changed
329  * @BSS_CHANGED_BSSID: BSSID changed, for whatever
330  *	reason (IBSS and managed mode)
331  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON: Beacon data changed, retrieve
332  *	new beacon (beaconing modes)
333  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED: Beaconing should be
334  *	enabled/disabled (beaconing modes)
335  * @BSS_CHANGED_CQM: Connection quality monitor config changed
336  * @BSS_CHANGED_IBSS: IBSS join status changed
337  * @BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER: Hardware ARP filter address list or state changed.
338  * @BSS_CHANGED_QOS: QoS for this association was enabled/disabled. Note
339  *	that it is only ever disabled for station mode.
340  * @BSS_CHANGED_IDLE: Idle changed for this BSS/interface.
341  * @BSS_CHANGED_SSID: SSID changed for this BSS (AP and IBSS mode)
342  * @BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response changed for this BSS (AP mode)
343  * @BSS_CHANGED_PS: PS changed for this BSS (STA mode)
344  * @BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER: TX power setting changed for this interface
345  * @BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS: P2P powersave settings (CTWindow, opportunistic PS)
346  *	changed
347  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO: Data from the AP's beacon became available:
348  *	currently dtim_period only is under consideration.
349  * @BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH: The bandwidth used by this interface changed,
350  *	note that this is only called when it changes after the channel
351  *	context had been assigned.
352  * @BSS_CHANGED_OCB: OCB join status changed
353  * @BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS: VHT MU-MIMO group id or user position changed
354  * @BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE: keep alive options (idle period or protected
355  *	keep alive) changed.
356  * @BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE: Multicast Rate setting changed for this interface
357  * @BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER: fine timing measurement request responder
358  *	functionality changed for this BSS (AP mode).
359  * @BSS_CHANGED_TWT: TWT status changed
360  * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD: OBSS Packet Detection status changed.
361  * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR: BSS Color has changed
362  * @BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY: FILS discovery status changed.
363  * @BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
364  *	status changed.
365  * @BSS_CHANGED_MLD_VALID_LINKS: MLD valid links status changed.
366  * @BSS_CHANGED_MLD_TTLM: negotiated TID to link mapping was changed
367  * @BSS_CHANGED_TPE: transmit power envelope changed
368  */
369 enum ieee80211_bss_change {
370 	BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC		= 1<<0,
371 	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT	= 1<<1,
372 	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE	= 1<<2,
373 	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT		= 1<<3,
374 	BSS_CHANGED_HT			= 1<<4,
375 	BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES		= 1<<5,
376 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT		= 1<<6,
377 	BSS_CHANGED_BSSID		= 1<<7,
378 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON		= 1<<8,
379 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED	= 1<<9,
380 	BSS_CHANGED_CQM			= 1<<10,
381 	BSS_CHANGED_IBSS		= 1<<11,
382 	BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER		= 1<<12,
383 	BSS_CHANGED_QOS			= 1<<13,
384 	BSS_CHANGED_IDLE		= 1<<14,
385 	BSS_CHANGED_SSID		= 1<<15,
386 	BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP	= 1<<16,
387 	BSS_CHANGED_PS			= 1<<17,
388 	BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER		= 1<<18,
389 	BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS		= 1<<19,
390 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO		= 1<<20,
391 	BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH		= 1<<21,
392 	BSS_CHANGED_OCB                 = 1<<22,
393 	BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS		= 1<<23,
394 	BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE		= 1<<24,
395 	BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE		= 1<<25,
396 	BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER	= 1<<26,
397 	BSS_CHANGED_TWT			= 1<<27,
398 	BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD		= 1<<28,
399 	BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR	= 1<<29,
400 	BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY      = 1<<30,
401 	BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP = BIT_ULL(31),
402 	BSS_CHANGED_MLD_VALID_LINKS	= BIT_ULL(33),
403 	BSS_CHANGED_MLD_TTLM		= BIT_ULL(34),
404 	BSS_CHANGED_TPE			= BIT_ULL(35),
405 
406 	/* when adding here, make sure to change ieee80211_reconfig */
407 };
408 
409 /*
410  * The maximum number of IPv4 addresses listed for ARP filtering. If the number
411  * of addresses for an interface increase beyond this value, hardware ARP
412  * filtering will be disabled.
413  */
414 #define IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN 4
415 
416 /**
417  * enum ieee80211_event_type - event to be notified to the low level driver
418  * @RSSI_EVENT: AP's rssi crossed the a threshold set by the driver.
419  * @MLME_EVENT: event related to MLME
420  * @BAR_RX_EVENT: a BAR was received
421  * @BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT: Frames were released from the reordering buffer because
422  *	they timed out. This won't be called for each frame released, but only
423  *	once each time the timeout triggers.
424  */
425 enum ieee80211_event_type {
426 	RSSI_EVENT,
427 	MLME_EVENT,
428 	BAR_RX_EVENT,
429 	BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT,
430 };
431 
432 /**
433  * enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data - relevant when event type is %RSSI_EVENT
434  * @RSSI_EVENT_HIGH: AP's rssi went below the threshold set by the driver.
435  * @RSSI_EVENT_LOW: AP's rssi went above the threshold set by the driver.
436  */
437 enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data {
438 	RSSI_EVENT_HIGH,
439 	RSSI_EVENT_LOW,
440 };
441 
442 /**
443  * struct ieee80211_rssi_event - data attached to an %RSSI_EVENT
444  * @data: See &enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data
445  */
446 struct ieee80211_rssi_event {
447 	enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data data;
448 };
449 
450 /**
451  * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
452  * @AUTH_EVENT: the MLME operation is authentication
453  * @ASSOC_EVENT: the MLME operation is association
454  * @DEAUTH_RX_EVENT: deauth received..
455  * @DEAUTH_TX_EVENT: deauth sent.
456  */
457 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data {
458 	AUTH_EVENT,
459 	ASSOC_EVENT,
460 	DEAUTH_RX_EVENT,
461 	DEAUTH_TX_EVENT,
462 };
463 
464 /**
465  * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
466  * @MLME_SUCCESS: the MLME operation completed successfully.
467  * @MLME_DENIED: the MLME operation was denied by the peer.
468  * @MLME_TIMEOUT: the MLME operation timed out.
469  */
470 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status {
471 	MLME_SUCCESS,
472 	MLME_DENIED,
473 	MLME_TIMEOUT,
474 };
475 
476 /**
477  * struct ieee80211_mlme_event - data attached to an %MLME_EVENT
478  * @data: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data
479  * @status: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status
480  * @reason: the reason code if applicable
481  */
482 struct ieee80211_mlme_event {
483 	enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data data;
484 	enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status status;
485 	u16 reason;
486 };
487 
488 /**
489  * struct ieee80211_ba_event - data attached for BlockAck related events
490  * @sta: pointer to the &ieee80211_sta to which this event relates
491  * @tid: the tid
492  * @ssn: the starting sequence number (for %BAR_RX_EVENT)
493  */
494 struct ieee80211_ba_event {
495 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
496 	u16 tid;
497 	u16 ssn;
498 };
499 
500 /**
501  * struct ieee80211_event - event to be sent to the driver
502  * @type: The event itself. See &enum ieee80211_event_type.
503  * @u.rssi: relevant if &type is %RSSI_EVENT
504  * @u.mlme: relevant if &type is %AUTH_EVENT
505  * @u.ba: relevant if &type is %BAR_RX_EVENT or %BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT
506  * @u:union holding the fields above
507  */
508 struct ieee80211_event {
509 	enum ieee80211_event_type type;
510 	union {
511 		struct ieee80211_rssi_event rssi;
512 		struct ieee80211_mlme_event mlme;
513 		struct ieee80211_ba_event ba;
514 	} u;
515 };
516 
517 /**
518  * struct ieee80211_mu_group_data - STA's VHT MU-MIMO group data
519  *
520  * This structure describes the group id data of VHT MU-MIMO
521  *
522  * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
523  * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
524  */
525 struct ieee80211_mu_group_data {
526 	u8 membership[WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN];
527 	u8 position[WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN];
528 };
529 
530 /**
531  * struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params - FTM responder parameters
532  *
533  * @lci: LCI subelement content
534  * @civicloc: CIVIC location subelement content
535  * @lci_len: LCI data length
536  * @civicloc_len: Civic data length
537  */
538 struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params {
539 	const u8 *lci;
540 	const u8 *civicloc;
541 	size_t lci_len;
542 	size_t civicloc_len;
543 };
544 
545 /**
546  * struct ieee80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from
547  * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
548  *
549  * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
550  * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
551  */
552 struct ieee80211_fils_discovery {
553 	u32 min_interval;
554 	u32 max_interval;
555 };
556 
557 #define IEEE80211_TPE_EIRP_ENTRIES_320MHZ	5
558 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_eirp {
559 	bool valid;
560 	s8 power[IEEE80211_TPE_EIRP_ENTRIES_320MHZ];
561 	u8 count;
562 };
563 
564 #define IEEE80211_TPE_PSD_ENTRIES_320MHZ	16
565 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_psd {
566 	bool valid;
567 	s8 power[IEEE80211_TPE_PSD_ENTRIES_320MHZ];
568 	u8 count, n;
569 };
570 
571 /**
572  * struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe - parsed transmit power envelope information
573  * @max_local: maximum local EIRP, one value for 20, 40, 80, 160, 320 MHz each
574  *	(indexed by TX power category)
575  * @max_reg_client: maximum regulatory client EIRP, one value for 20, 40, 80,
576  *	160, 320 MHz each
577  *	(indexed by TX power category)
578  * @psd_local: maximum local power spectral density, one value for each 20 MHz
579  *	subchannel per bss_conf's chanreq.oper
580  *	(indexed by TX power category)
581  * @psd_reg_client: maximum regulatory power spectral density, one value for
582  *	each 20 MHz subchannel per bss_conf's chanreq.oper
583  *	(indexed by TX power category)
584  */
585 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe {
586 	struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_eirp max_local[2], max_reg_client[2];
587 	struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_psd psd_local[2], psd_reg_client[2];
588 };
589 
590 /**
591  * struct ieee80211_bss_conf - holds the BSS's changing parameters
592  *
593  * This structure keeps information about a BSS (and an association
594  * to that BSS) that can change during the lifetime of the BSS.
595  *
596  * @vif: reference to owning VIF
597  * @bss: the cfg80211 bss descriptor. Valid only for a station, and only
598  *	when associated. Note: This contains information which is not
599  *	necessarily authenticated. For example, information coming from probe
600  *	responses.
601  * @addr: (link) address used locally
602  * @link_id: link ID, or 0 for non-MLO
603  * @htc_trig_based_pkt_ext: default PE in 4us units, if BSS supports HE
604  * @uora_exists: is the UORA element advertised by AP
605  * @uora_ocw_range: UORA element's OCW Range field
606  * @frame_time_rts_th: HE duration RTS threshold, in units of 32us
607  * @he_support: does this BSS support HE
608  * @twt_requester: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
609  *	mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
610  * @twt_responder: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
611  *	mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
612  * @twt_protected: does this BSS support protected TWT frames
613  * @twt_broadcast: does this BSS support broadcast TWT
614  * @use_cts_prot: use CTS protection
615  * @use_short_preamble: use 802.11b short preamble
616  * @use_short_slot: use short slot time (only relevant for ERP)
617  * @dtim_period: num of beacons before the next DTIM, for beaconing,
618  *	valid in station mode only if after the driver was notified
619  *	with the %BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO flag, will be non-zero then.
620  * @sync_tsf: last beacon's/probe response's TSF timestamp (could be old
621  *	as it may have been received during scanning long ago). If the
622  *	HW flag %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY is set, then this can
623  *	only come from a beacon, but might not become valid until after
624  *	association when a beacon is received (which is notified with the
625  *	%BSS_CHANGED_DTIM flag.). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
626  * @sync_device_ts: the device timestamp corresponding to the sync_tsf,
627  *	the driver/device can use this to calculate synchronisation
628  *	(see @sync_tsf). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
629  * @sync_dtim_count: Only valid when %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY
630  *	is requested, see @sync_tsf/@sync_device_ts.
631  *	IMPORTANT: These three sync_* parameters would possibly be out of sync
632  *	by the time the driver will use them. The synchronized view is currently
633  *	guaranteed only in certain callbacks.
634  *	Note also that this is not used with MLD associations, mac80211 doesn't
635  *	know how to track beacons for all of the links for this.
636  * @beacon_int: beacon interval
637  * @assoc_capability: capabilities taken from assoc resp
638  * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates, each bit stands for an
639  *	index into the rate table configured by the driver in
640  *	the current band.
641  * @beacon_rate: associated AP's beacon TX rate
642  * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
643  * @bssid: The BSSID for this BSS
644  * @enable_beacon: whether beaconing should be enabled or not
645  * @chanreq: Channel request for this BSS -- the hardware might be
646  *	configured a higher bandwidth than this BSS uses, for example.
647  * @mu_group: VHT MU-MIMO group membership data
648  * @ht_operation_mode: HT operation mode like in &struct ieee80211_ht_operation.
649  *	This field is only valid when the channel is a wide HT/VHT channel.
650  *	Note that with TDLS this can be the case (channel is HT, protection must
651  *	be used from this field) even when the BSS association isn't using HT.
652  * @cqm_rssi_thold: Connection quality monitor RSSI threshold, a zero value
653  *	implies disabled. As with the cfg80211 callback, a change here should
654  *	cause an event to be sent indicating where the current value is in
655  *	relation to the newly configured threshold.
656  * @cqm_rssi_low: Connection quality monitor RSSI lower threshold, a zero value
657  *	implies disabled.  This is an alternative mechanism to the single
658  *	threshold event and can't be enabled simultaneously with it.
659  * @cqm_rssi_high: Connection quality monitor RSSI upper threshold.
660  * @cqm_rssi_hyst: Connection quality monitor RSSI hysteresis
661  * @qos: This is a QoS-enabled BSS.
662  * @hidden_ssid: The SSID of the current vif is hidden. Only valid in AP-mode.
663  * @txpower: TX power in dBm.  INT_MIN means not configured.
664  * @txpower_type: TX power adjustment used to control per packet Transmit
665  *	Power Control (TPC) in lower driver for the current vif. In particular
666  *	TPC is enabled if value passed in %txpower_type is
667  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED (allow using less than specified from
668  *	userspace), whereas TPC is disabled if %txpower_type is set to
669  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED (use value configured from userspace)
670  * @p2p_noa_attr: P2P NoA attribute for P2P powersave
671  * @allow_p2p_go_ps: indication for AP or P2P GO interface, whether it's allowed
672  *	to use P2P PS mechanism or not. AP/P2P GO is not allowed to use P2P PS
673  *	if it has associated clients without P2P PS support.
674  * @max_idle_period: the time period during which the station can refrain from
675  *	transmitting frames to its associated AP without being disassociated.
676  *	In units of 1000 TUs. Zero value indicates that the AP did not include
677  *	a (valid) BSS Max Idle Period Element.
678  * @protected_keep_alive: if set, indicates that the station should send an RSN
679  *	protected frame to the AP to reset the idle timer at the AP for the
680  *	station.
681  * @ftm_responder: whether to enable or disable fine timing measurement FTM
682  *	responder functionality.
683  * @ftmr_params: configurable lci/civic parameter when enabling FTM responder.
684  * @nontransmitted: this BSS is a nontransmitted BSS profile
685  * @tx_bss_conf: Pointer to the BSS configuration of transmitting interface
686  *	if MBSSID is enabled. This pointer is RCU-protected due to CSA finish
687  *	and BSS color change flows accessing it.
688  * @transmitter_bssid: the address of transmitter AP
689  * @bssid_index: index inside the multiple BSSID set
690  * @bssid_indicator: 2^bssid_indicator is the maximum number of APs in set
691  * @ema_ap: AP supports enhancements of discovery and advertisement of
692  *	nontransmitted BSSIDs
693  * @profile_periodicity: the least number of beacon frames need to be received
694  *	in order to discover all the nontransmitted BSSIDs in the set.
695  * @he_oper: HE operation information of the BSS (AP/Mesh) or of the AP we are
696  *	connected to (STA)
697  * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection parameters.
698  * @he_bss_color: BSS coloring settings, if BSS supports HE
699  * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery configuration
700  * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
701  *	interval.
702  * @beacon_tx_rate: The configured beacon transmit rate that needs to be passed
703  *	to driver when rate control is offloaded to firmware.
704  * @power_type: power type of BSS for 6 GHz
705  * @tpe: transmit power envelope information
706  * @pwr_reduction: power constraint of BSS.
707  * @eht_support: does this BSS support EHT
708  * @epcs_support: does this BSS support EPCS
709  * @csa_active: marks whether a channel switch is going on.
710  * @mu_mimo_owner: indicates interface owns MU-MIMO capability
711  * @chanctx_conf: The channel context this interface is assigned to, or %NULL
712  *	when it is not assigned. This pointer is RCU-protected due to the TX
713  *	path needing to access it; even though the netdev carrier will always
714  *	be off when it is %NULL there can still be races and packets could be
715  *	processed after it switches back to %NULL.
716  * @color_change_active: marks whether a color change is ongoing.
717  * @color_change_color: the bss color that will be used after the change.
718  * @ht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HT LDPC capability.
719  * @vht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has VHT LDPC capability.
720  * @he_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HE LDPC capability.
721  * @vht_su_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
722  *	beamformer
723  * @vht_su_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
724  *	beamformee
725  * @vht_mu_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
726  *	beamformer
727  * @vht_mu_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
728  *	beamformee
729  * @he_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
730  *	beamformer
731  * @he_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
732  *	beamformee
733  * @he_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE MU
734  *	beamformer
735  * @he_full_ul_mumimo: does this BSS support the reception (AP) or transmission
736  *	(non-AP STA) of an HE TB PPDU on an RU that spans the entire PPDU
737  *	bandwidth
738  * @eht_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU
739  *	beamformer
740  * @eht_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU
741  *	beamformee
742  * @eht_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT MU
743  *	beamformer
744  * @eht_80mhz_full_bw_ul_mumimo: in AP-mode, does this BSS support the
745  *	reception of an EHT TB PPDU on an RU that spans the entire PPDU
746  *	bandwidth
747  * @eht_disable_mcs15: disable EHT-MCS 15 reception capability.
748  * @bss_param_ch_cnt: in BSS-mode, the BSS params change count. This
749  *	information is the latest known value. It can come from this link's
750  *	beacon or from a beacon sent by another link.
751  * @bss_param_ch_cnt_link_id: in BSS-mode, the link_id to which the beacon
752  *	that updated &bss_param_ch_cnt belongs. E.g. if link 1 doesn't hear
753  *	its beacons, and link 2 sent a beacon with an RNR element that updated
754  *	link 1's BSS params change count, then, link 1's
755  *	bss_param_ch_cnt_link_id will be 2. That means that link 1 knows that
756  *	link 2 was the link that updated its bss_param_ch_cnt value.
757  *	In case link 1 hears its beacon again, bss_param_ch_cnt_link_id will
758  *	be updated to 1, even if bss_param_ch_cnt didn't change. This allows
759  *	the link to know that it heard the latest value from its own beacon
760  *	(as opposed to hearing its value from another link's beacon).
761  * @s1g_long_beacon_period: number of beacon intervals between each long
762  *	beacon transmission.
763  */
764 struct ieee80211_bss_conf {
765 	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
766 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
767 
768 	const u8 *bssid;
769 	unsigned int link_id;
770 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
771 	u8 htc_trig_based_pkt_ext;
772 	bool uora_exists;
773 	u8 uora_ocw_range;
774 	u16 frame_time_rts_th;
775 	bool he_support;
776 	bool twt_requester;
777 	bool twt_responder;
778 	bool twt_protected;
779 	bool twt_broadcast;
780 	/* erp related data */
781 	bool use_cts_prot;
782 	bool use_short_preamble;
783 	bool use_short_slot;
784 	bool enable_beacon;
785 	u8 dtim_period;
786 	u16 beacon_int;
787 	u16 assoc_capability;
788 	u64 sync_tsf;
789 	u32 sync_device_ts;
790 	u8 sync_dtim_count;
791 	u32 basic_rates;
792 	struct ieee80211_rate *beacon_rate;
793 	int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
794 	u16 ht_operation_mode;
795 	s32 cqm_rssi_thold;
796 	u32 cqm_rssi_hyst;
797 	s32 cqm_rssi_low;
798 	s32 cqm_rssi_high;
799 	struct ieee80211_chan_req chanreq;
800 	struct ieee80211_mu_group_data mu_group;
801 	bool qos;
802 	bool hidden_ssid;
803 	int txpower;
804 	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting txpower_type;
805 	struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr p2p_noa_attr;
806 	bool allow_p2p_go_ps;
807 	u16 max_idle_period;
808 	bool protected_keep_alive;
809 	bool ftm_responder;
810 	struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params *ftmr_params;
811 	/* Multiple BSSID data */
812 	bool nontransmitted;
813 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf __rcu *tx_bss_conf;
814 	u8 transmitter_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
815 	u8 bssid_index;
816 	u8 bssid_indicator;
817 	bool ema_ap;
818 	u8 profile_periodicity;
819 	struct {
820 		u32 params;
821 		u16 nss_set;
822 	} he_oper;
823 	struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd;
824 	struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color;
825 	struct ieee80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
826 	u32 unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval;
827 	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_tx_rate;
828 	enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power power_type;
829 
830 	struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe tpe;
831 
832 	u8 pwr_reduction;
833 	bool eht_support;
834 	bool epcs_support;
835 	bool csa_active;
836 
837 	bool mu_mimo_owner;
838 	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf __rcu *chanctx_conf;
839 
840 	bool color_change_active;
841 	u8 color_change_color;
842 
843 	bool ht_ldpc;
844 	bool vht_ldpc;
845 	bool he_ldpc;
846 	bool vht_su_beamformer;
847 	bool vht_su_beamformee;
848 	bool vht_mu_beamformer;
849 	bool vht_mu_beamformee;
850 	bool he_su_beamformer;
851 	bool he_su_beamformee;
852 	bool he_mu_beamformer;
853 	bool he_full_ul_mumimo;
854 	bool eht_su_beamformer;
855 	bool eht_su_beamformee;
856 	bool eht_mu_beamformer;
857 	bool eht_80mhz_full_bw_ul_mumimo;
858 	bool eht_disable_mcs15;
859 
860 	u8 bss_param_ch_cnt;
861 	u8 bss_param_ch_cnt_link_id;
862 
863 	u8 s1g_long_beacon_period;
864 };
865 
866 /**
867  * enum mac80211_tx_info_flags - flags to describe transmission information/status
868  *
869  * These flags are used with the @flags member of &ieee80211_tx_info.
870  *
871  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS: require TX status callback for this frame.
872  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ: The driver has to assign a sequence
873  *	number to this frame, taking care of not overwriting the fragment
874  *	number and increasing the sequence number only when the
875  *	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT flag is set. mac80211 will properly
876  *	assign sequence numbers to QoS-data frames but cannot do so correctly
877  *	for non-QoS-data and management frames because beacons need them from
878  *	that counter as well and mac80211 cannot guarantee proper sequencing.
879  *	If this flag is set, the driver should instruct the hardware to
880  *	assign a sequence number to the frame or assign one itself. Cf. IEEE
881  *	802.11-2007 7.1.3.4.1 paragraph 3. This flag will always be set for
882  *	beacons and always be clear for frames without a sequence number field.
883  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK: tell the low level not to wait for an ack
884  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT: clear powersave filter for destination
885  *	station
886  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT: this is a first fragment of the frame
887  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM: send this frame after DTIM beacon
888  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU: this frame should be sent as part of an A-MPDU
889  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED: Frame was injected, internal to mac80211.
890  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED: The frame was not transmitted
891  *	because the destination STA was in powersave mode. Note that to
892  *	avoid race conditions, the filter must be set by the hardware or
893  *	firmware upon receiving a frame that indicates that the station
894  *	went to sleep (must be done on device to filter frames already on
895  *	the queue) and may only be unset after mac80211 gives the OK for
896  *	that by setting the IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT (see above),
897  *	since only then is it guaranteed that no more frames are in the
898  *	hardware queue.
899  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK: Frame was acknowledged
900  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU: The frame was aggregated, so status
901  * 	is for the whole aggregation.
902  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK: no block ack was returned,
903  * 	so consider using block ack request (BAR).
904  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE: internal to mac80211, can be
905  *	set by rate control algorithms to indicate probe rate, will
906  *	be cleared for fragmented frames (except on the last fragment)
907  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK: Internal to mac80211. Used to indicate
908  *	that a frame can be transmitted while the queues are stopped for
909  *	off-channel operation.
910  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP: This frame uses hardware encapsulation
911  *	(header conversion)
912  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED: completely internal to mac80211,
913  *	used to indicate that a frame was already retried due to PS
914  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT: completely internal to mac80211,
915  *	used to indicate frame should not be encrypted
916  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER: This frame is a response to a poll
917  *	frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD) or a non-bufferable MMPDU and must
918  *	be sent although the station is in powersave mode.
919  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES: More frames will be passed to the
920  *	transmit function after the current frame, this can be used
921  *	by drivers to kick the DMA queue only if unset or when the
922  *	queue gets full.
923  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION: This frame is being retransmitted
924  *	after TX status because the destination was asleep, it must not
925  *	be modified again (no seqno assignment, crypto, etc.)
926  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX: This frame was transmitted by the MLME
927  *	code for connection establishment, this indicates that its status
928  *	should kick the MLME state machine.
929  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX: Frame was requested through nl80211
930  *	MLME command (internal to mac80211 to figure out whether to send TX
931  *	status to user space)
932  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC: tells the driver to use LDPC for this frame
933  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC: Enables Space-Time Block Coding (STBC) for this
934  *	frame and selects the maximum number of streams that it can use.
935  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN: Marks this packet to be transmitted on
936  *	the off-channel channel when a remain-on-channel offload is done
937  *	in hardware -- normal packets still flow and are expected to be
938  *	handled properly by the device.
939  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE: Marks this packet to be used for TKIP
940  *	testing. It will be sent out with incorrect Michael MIC key to allow
941  *	TKIP countermeasures to be tested.
942  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE: This frame will be sent at non CCK rate.
943  *	This flag is actually used for management frame especially for P2P
944  *	frames not being sent at CCK rate in 2GHz band.
945  * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP: This packet marks the end of service period,
946  *	when its status is reported the service period ends. For frames in
947  *	an SP that mac80211 transmits, it is already set; for driver frames
948  *	the driver may set this flag. It is also used to do the same for
949  *	PS-Poll responses.
950  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE: This frame will be sent at lowest rate.
951  *	This flag is used to send nullfunc frame at minimum rate when
952  *	the nullfunc is used for connection monitoring purpose.
953  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG: Don't fragment this packet even if it
954  *	would be fragmented by size (this is optional, only used for
955  *	monitor injection).
956  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED: A frame that was marked with
957  *	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK has been successfully transmitted without
958  *	any errors (like issues specific to the driver/HW).
959  *	This flag must not be set for frames that don't request no-ack
960  *	behaviour with IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK.
961  *
962  * Note: If you have to add new flags to the enumeration, then don't
963  *	 forget to update %IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS when necessary.
964  */
965 enum mac80211_tx_info_flags {
966 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS		= BIT(0),
967 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ		= BIT(1),
968 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK			= BIT(2),
969 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT		= BIT(3),
970 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT		= BIT(4),
971 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM	= BIT(5),
972 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU			= BIT(6),
973 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED		= BIT(7),
974 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED		= BIT(8),
975 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK			= BIT(9),
976 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU			= BIT(10),
977 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK		= BIT(11),
978 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE	= BIT(12),
979 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK	= BIT(13),
980 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP		= BIT(14),
981 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED		= BIT(15),
982 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT		= BIT(16),
983 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER		= BIT(17),
984 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES		= BIT(18),
985 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION	= BIT(19),
986 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX		= BIT(20),
987 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX	= BIT(21),
988 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC			= BIT(22),
989 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC			= BIT(23) | BIT(24),
990 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN		= BIT(25),
991 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE	= BIT(26),
992 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE		= BIT(27),
993 	IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP		= BIT(28),
994 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE		= BIT(29),
995 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG		= BIT(30),
996 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED	= BIT(31),
997 };
998 
999 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC_SHIFT		23
1000 
1001 #define IEEE80211_TX_RC_S1G_MCS IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS
1002 
1003 /**
1004  * enum mac80211_tx_control_flags - flags to describe transmit control
1005  *
1006  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO: this frame is a port control
1007  *	protocol frame (e.g. EAP)
1008  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE: This frame is a response to a poll
1009  *	frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD).
1010  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT: This frame is injected with rate information
1011  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU: This frame is an A-MSDU frame
1012  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT: This frame is going through the fast_xmit path
1013  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP: This frame skips mesh path lookup
1014  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING: completely internal to mac80211,
1015  *	used to indicate that a pending frame requires TX processing before
1016  *	it can be sent out.
1017  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO: Do not overwrite the sequence number that
1018  *	has already been assigned to this frame.
1019  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER: This frame should not be reordered
1020  *	relative to other frames that have this flag set, independent
1021  *	of their QoS TID or other priority field values.
1022  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX: first MLO TX, used mostly internally
1023  *	for sequence number assignment
1024  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_USE_RATE_MASK: Don't use rate mask for this frame
1025  *	which is transmitted due to scanning or offchannel TX, not in normal
1026  *	operation on the interface.
1027  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK: If not @IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, this
1028  *	frame should be transmitted on the specific link. This really is
1029  *	only relevant for frames that do not have data present, and is
1030  *	also not used for 802.3 format frames. Note that even if the frame
1031  *	is on a specific link, address translation might still apply if
1032  *	it's intended for an MLD.
1033  *
1034  * These flags are used in tx_info->control.flags.
1035  */
1036 enum mac80211_tx_control_flags {
1037 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO	= BIT(0),
1038 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE		= BIT(1),
1039 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT		= BIT(2),
1040 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU			= BIT(3),
1041 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT		= BIT(4),
1042 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP	= BIT(5),
1043 	IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING	= BIT(6),
1044 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO		= BIT(7),
1045 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER		= BIT(8),
1046 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX	= BIT(9),
1047 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_USE_RATE_MASK	= BIT(10),
1048 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK		= 0xf0000000,
1049 };
1050 
1051 #define IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED	0xf
1052 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK_UNSPEC	\
1053 	u32_encode_bits(IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, \
1054 			IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK)
1055 
1056 /**
1057  * enum mac80211_tx_status_flags - flags to describe transmit status
1058  *
1059  * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID: ACK signal is valid
1060  *
1061  * These flags are used in tx_info->status.flags.
1062  */
1063 enum mac80211_tx_status_flags {
1064 	IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID = BIT(0),
1065 };
1066 
1067 /*
1068  * This definition is used as a mask to clear all temporary flags, which are
1069  * set by the tx handlers for each transmission attempt by the mac80211 stack.
1070  */
1071 #define IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS (IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK |		      \
1072 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT |    \
1073 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU |	      \
1074 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED |	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK |		      \
1075 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK |	      \
1076 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER |    \
1077 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC |		      \
1078 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC | IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
1079 
1080 /**
1081  * enum mac80211_rate_control_flags - per-rate flags set by the
1082  *	Rate Control algorithm.
1083  *
1084  * These flags are set by the Rate control algorithm for each rate during tx,
1085  * in the @flags member of struct ieee80211_tx_rate.
1086  *
1087  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS: Use RTS/CTS exchange for this rate.
1088  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT: CTS-to-self protection is required.
1089  *	This is set if the current BSS requires ERP protection.
1090  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Use short preamble.
1091  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS: HT rate.
1092  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS: VHT MCS rate, in this case the idx field is split
1093  *	into a higher 4 bits (Nss) and lower 4 bits (MCS number)
1094  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD: Indicates whether this rate should be used in
1095  *	Greenfield mode.
1096  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates if the Channel Width should be 40 MHz.
1097  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 80 MHz transmission
1098  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 160 MHz transmission
1099  *	(80+80 isn't supported yet)
1100  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA: The frame should be transmitted on both of the
1101  *	adjacent 20 MHz channels, if the current channel type is
1102  *	NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS or NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS.
1103  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI: Short Guard interval should be used for this rate.
1104  */
1105 enum mac80211_rate_control_flags {
1106 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS		= BIT(0),
1107 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT		= BIT(1),
1108 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= BIT(2),
1109 
1110 	/* rate index is an HT/VHT MCS instead of an index */
1111 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS			= BIT(3),
1112 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD		= BIT(4),
1113 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(5),
1114 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA		= BIT(6),
1115 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI		= BIT(7),
1116 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS			= BIT(8),
1117 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(9),
1118 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(10),
1119 };
1120 
1121 
1122 /* there are 40 bytes if you don't need the rateset to be kept */
1123 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 40
1124 
1125 /* if you do need the rateset, then you have less space */
1126 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 24
1127 
1128 /* maximum number of rate stages */
1129 #define IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES	4
1130 
1131 /* maximum number of rate table entries */
1132 #define IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE	4
1133 
1134 /**
1135  * struct ieee80211_tx_rate - rate selection/status
1136  *
1137  * @idx: rate index to attempt to send with
1138  * @flags: rate control flags (&enum mac80211_rate_control_flags)
1139  * @count: number of tries in this rate before going to the next rate
1140  *
1141  * A value of -1 for @idx indicates an invalid rate and, if used
1142  * in an array of retry rates, that no more rates should be tried.
1143  *
1144  * When used for transmit status reporting, the driver should
1145  * always report the rate along with the flags it used.
1146  *
1147  * &struct ieee80211_tx_info contains an array of these structs
1148  * in the control information, and it will be filled by the rate
1149  * control algorithm according to what should be sent. For example,
1150  * if this array contains, in the format { <idx>, <count> } the
1151  * information::
1152  *
1153  *    { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 4 }, { -1, 0 }, { -1, 0 }
1154  *
1155  * then this means that the frame should be transmitted
1156  * up to twice at rate 3, up to twice at rate 2, and up to four
1157  * times at rate 1 if it doesn't get acknowledged. Say it gets
1158  * acknowledged by the peer after the fifth attempt, the status
1159  * information should then contain::
1160  *
1161  *   { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 1 }, { -1, 0 } ...
1162  *
1163  * since it was transmitted twice at rate 3, twice at rate 2
1164  * and once at rate 1 after which we received an acknowledgement.
1165  */
1166 struct ieee80211_tx_rate {
1167 	s8 idx;
1168 	u16 count:5,
1169 	    flags:11;
1170 } __packed;
1171 
1172 #define IEEE80211_MAX_TX_RETRY		31
1173 
ieee80211_rate_valid(struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate)1174 static inline bool ieee80211_rate_valid(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1175 {
1176 	return rate->idx >= 0 && rate->count > 0;
1177 }
1178 
ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate,u8 mcs,u8 nss)1179 static inline void ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate,
1180 					  u8 mcs, u8 nss)
1181 {
1182 	WARN_ON(mcs & ~0xF);
1183 	WARN_ON((nss - 1) & ~0x7);
1184 	rate->idx = ((nss - 1) << 4) | mcs;
1185 }
1186 
1187 static inline u8
ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate)1188 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1189 {
1190 	return rate->idx & 0xF;
1191 }
1192 
1193 static inline u8
ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate)1194 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1195 {
1196 	return (rate->idx >> 4) + 1;
1197 }
1198 
1199 /**
1200  * struct ieee80211_tx_info - skb transmit information
1201  *
1202  * This structure is placed in skb->cb for three uses:
1203  *  (1) mac80211 TX control - mac80211 tells the driver what to do
1204  *  (2) driver internal use (if applicable)
1205  *  (3) TX status information - driver tells mac80211 what happened
1206  *
1207  * @flags: transmit info flags, defined above
1208  * @band: the band to transmit on (use e.g. for checking for races),
1209  *	not valid if the interface is an MLD since we won't know which
1210  *	link the frame will be transmitted on
1211  * @hw_queue: HW queue to put the frame on, skb_get_queue_mapping() gives the AC
1212  * @status_data: internal data for TX status handling, assigned privately,
1213  *	see also &enum ieee80211_status_data for the internal documentation
1214  * @status_data_idr: indicates status data is IDR allocated ID for ack frame
1215  * @tx_time_est: TX time estimate in units of 4us, used internally
1216  * @control: union part for control data
1217  * @control.rates: TX rates array to try
1218  * @control.rts_cts_rate_idx: rate for RTS or CTS
1219  * @control.use_rts: use RTS
1220  * @control.use_cts_prot: use RTS/CTS
1221  * @control.short_preamble: use short preamble (CCK only)
1222  * @control.skip_table: skip externally configured rate table
1223  * @control.jiffies: timestamp for expiry on powersave clients
1224  * @control.vif: virtual interface (may be NULL)
1225  * @control.hw_key: key to encrypt with (may be NULL)
1226  * @control.flags: control flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_control_flags
1227  * @control.enqueue_time: enqueue time (for iTXQs)
1228  * @driver_rates: alias to @control.rates to reserve space
1229  * @pad: padding
1230  * @rate_driver_data: driver use area if driver needs @control.rates
1231  * @status: union part for status data
1232  * @status.rates: attempted rates
1233  * @status.ack_signal: ACK signal
1234  * @status.ampdu_ack_len: AMPDU ack length
1235  * @status.ampdu_len: AMPDU length
1236  * @status.antenna: (legacy, kept only for iwlegacy)
1237  * @status.tx_time: airtime consumed for transmission; note this is only
1238  *	used for WMM AC, not for airtime fairness
1239  * @status.flags: status flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_status_flags
1240  * @status.status_driver_data: driver use area
1241  * @ack: union part for pure ACK data
1242  * @ack.cookie: cookie for the ACK
1243  * @driver_data: array of driver_data pointers
1244  */
1245 struct ieee80211_tx_info {
1246 	/* common information */
1247 	u32 flags;
1248 	u32 band:3,
1249 	    status_data_idr:1,
1250 	    status_data:13,
1251 	    hw_queue:4,
1252 	    tx_time_est:10;
1253 	/* 1 free bit */
1254 
1255 	union {
1256 		struct {
1257 			union {
1258 				/* rate control */
1259 				struct {
1260 					struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[
1261 						IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1262 					s8 rts_cts_rate_idx;
1263 					u8 use_rts:1;
1264 					u8 use_cts_prot:1;
1265 					u8 short_preamble:1;
1266 					u8 skip_table:1;
1267 
1268 					/* for injection only (bitmap) */
1269 					u8 antennas:2;
1270 
1271 					/* 14 bits free */
1272 				};
1273 				/* only needed before rate control */
1274 				unsigned long jiffies;
1275 			};
1276 			/* NB: vif can be NULL for injected frames */
1277 			struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
1278 			struct ieee80211_key_conf *hw_key;
1279 			u32 flags;
1280 			codel_time_t enqueue_time;
1281 		} control;
1282 		struct {
1283 			u64 cookie;
1284 		} ack;
1285 		struct {
1286 			struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1287 			s32 ack_signal;
1288 			u8 ampdu_ack_len;
1289 			u8 ampdu_len;
1290 			u8 antenna;
1291 			u8 pad;
1292 			u16 tx_time;
1293 			u8 flags;
1294 			u8 pad2;
1295 			void *status_driver_data[16 / sizeof(void *)];
1296 		} status;
1297 		struct {
1298 			struct ieee80211_tx_rate driver_rates[
1299 				IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1300 			u8 pad[4];
1301 
1302 			void *rate_driver_data[
1303 				IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1304 		};
1305 		void *driver_data[
1306 			IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1307 	};
1308 };
1309 
1310 static inline u16
ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info * info,u16 tx_time_est)1311 ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info, u16 tx_time_est)
1312 {
1313 	/* We only have 10 bits in tx_time_est, so store airtime
1314 	 * in increments of 4us and clamp the maximum to 2**12-1
1315 	 */
1316 	info->tx_time_est = min_t(u16, tx_time_est, 4095) >> 2;
1317 	return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1318 }
1319 
1320 static inline u16
ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info * info)1321 ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1322 {
1323 	return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1324 }
1325 
1326 /***
1327  * struct ieee80211_rate_status - mrr stage for status path
1328  *
1329  * This struct is used in struct ieee80211_tx_status to provide drivers a
1330  * dynamic way to report about used rates and power levels per packet.
1331  *
1332  * @rate_idx The actual used rate.
1333  * @try_count How often the rate was tried.
1334  * @tx_power_idx An idx into the ieee80211_hw->tx_power_levels list of the
1335  * 	corresponding wifi hardware. The idx shall point to the power level
1336  * 	that was used when sending the packet.
1337  */
1338 struct ieee80211_rate_status {
1339 	struct rate_info rate_idx;
1340 	u8 try_count;
1341 	u8 tx_power_idx;
1342 };
1343 
1344 /**
1345  * struct ieee80211_tx_status - extended tx status info for rate control
1346  *
1347  * @sta: Station that the packet was transmitted for
1348  * @info: Basic tx status information
1349  * @skb: Packet skb (can be NULL if not provided by the driver)
1350  * @rates: Mrr stages that were used when sending the packet
1351  * @n_rates: Number of mrr stages (count of instances for @rates)
1352  * @free_list: list where processed skbs are stored to be free'd by the driver
1353  * @ack_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp of the received ack in nanoseconds
1354  *	Only needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action
1355  *	frames. Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1356  */
1357 struct ieee80211_tx_status {
1358 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
1359 	struct ieee80211_tx_info *info;
1360 	struct sk_buff *skb;
1361 	struct ieee80211_rate_status *rates;
1362 	ktime_t ack_hwtstamp;
1363 	u8 n_rates;
1364 
1365 	struct list_head *free_list;
1366 };
1367 
1368 /**
1369  * struct ieee80211_scan_ies - descriptors for different blocks of IEs
1370  *
1371  * This structure is used to point to different blocks of IEs in HW scan
1372  * and scheduled scan. These blocks contain the IEs passed by userspace
1373  * and the ones generated by mac80211.
1374  *
1375  * @ies: pointers to band specific IEs.
1376  * @len: lengths of band_specific IEs.
1377  * @common_ies: IEs for all bands (especially vendor specific ones)
1378  * @common_ie_len: length of the common_ies
1379  */
1380 struct ieee80211_scan_ies {
1381 	const u8 *ies[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1382 	size_t len[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1383 	const u8 *common_ies;
1384 	size_t common_ie_len;
1385 };
1386 
1387 
IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff * skb)1388 static inline struct ieee80211_tx_info *IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1389 {
1390 	return (struct ieee80211_tx_info *)skb->cb;
1391 }
1392 
IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff * skb)1393 static inline struct ieee80211_rx_status *IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1394 {
1395 	return (struct ieee80211_rx_status *)skb->cb;
1396 }
1397 
1398 /**
1399  * ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status - clear TX status
1400  *
1401  * @info: The &struct ieee80211_tx_info to be cleared.
1402  *
1403  * When the driver passes an skb back to mac80211, it must report
1404  * a number of things in TX status. This function clears everything
1405  * in the TX status but the rate control information (it does clear
1406  * the count since you need to fill that in anyway).
1407  *
1408  * NOTE: While the rates array is kept intact, this will wipe all of the
1409  *	 driver_data fields in info, so it's up to the driver to restore
1410  *	 any fields it needs after calling this helper.
1411  */
1412 static inline void
ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info * info)1413 ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1414 {
1415 	int i;
1416 
1417 	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1418 		     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, control.rates));
1419 	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1420 		     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, driver_rates));
1421 	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 8);
1422 	/* clear the rate counts */
1423 	for (i = 0; i < IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES; i++)
1424 		info->status.rates[i].count = 0;
1425 	memset_after(&info->status, 0, rates);
1426 }
1427 
1428 
1429 /**
1430  * enum mac80211_rx_flags - receive flags
1431  *
1432  * These flags are used with the @flag member of &struct ieee80211_rx_status.
1433  * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR: Michael MIC error was reported on this frame.
1434  *	Use together with %RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED.
1435  * @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED: This frame was decrypted in hardware.
1436  * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED: the Michael MIC is stripped off this frame,
1437  *	verification has been done by the hardware.
1438  * @RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED: The IV and ICV are stripped from this frame.
1439  *	If this flag is set, the stack cannot do any replay detection
1440  *	hence the driver or hardware will have to do that.
1441  * @RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED: Currently only valid for CCMP/GCMP frames, this
1442  *	flag indicates that the PN was verified for replay protection.
1443  *	Note that this flag is also currently only supported when a frame
1444  *	is also decrypted (ie. @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED must be set)
1445  * @RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED: The driver should set this flag if it did
1446  *	de-duplication by itself.
1447  * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC: Set this flag if the FCS check failed on
1448  *	the frame.
1449  * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC: Set this flag if the PCLP check failed on
1450  *	the frame.
1451  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1452  *	field) is valid if this field is non-zero, and the position
1453  *	where the timestamp was sampled depends on the value.
1454  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1455  *	field) is valid and contains the time the first symbol of the MPDU
1456  *	was received. This is useful in monitor mode and for proper IBSS
1457  *	merging.
1458  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1459  *	field) is valid and contains the time the last symbol of the MPDU
1460  *	(including FCS) was received.
1461  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1462  *	field) is valid and contains the time the SYNC preamble was received.
1463  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_IS_RTAP_TS64: The timestamp passed in the RX status @mactime
1464  *	is only for use in the radiotap timestamp header, not otherwise a valid
1465  *	@mactime value. Note this is a separate flag so that we continue to see
1466  *	%RX_FLAG_MACTIME as unset. Also note that in this case the timestamp is
1467  *	reported to be 64 bits wide, not just 32.
1468  * @RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL: The signal strength value is not present.
1469  *	Valid only for data frames (mainly A-MPDU)
1470  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS: A-MPDU details are known, in particular the reference
1471  *	number (@ampdu_reference) must be populated and be a distinct number for
1472  *	each A-MPDU
1473  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN: last subframe is known, should be set on all
1474  *	subframes of a single A-MPDU
1475  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST: this subframe is the last subframe of the A-MPDU
1476  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR: A delimiter CRC error has been detected
1477  *	on this subframe
1478  * @RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED: The mic was stripped of this packet. Decryption was
1479  *	done by the hardware
1480  * @RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR: Report frame only to monitor interfaces without
1481  *	processing it in any regular way.
1482  *	This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1483  *	them for sniffing purposes.
1484  * @RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR: Process and report frame to all interfaces except
1485  *	monitor interfaces.
1486  *	This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1487  *	them for sniffing purposes.
1488  * @RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE: Some drivers may prefer to report separate A-MSDU
1489  *	subframes instead of a one huge frame for performance reasons.
1490  *	All, but the last MSDU from an A-MSDU should have this flag set. E.g.
1491  *	if an A-MSDU has 3 frames, the first 2 must have the flag set, while
1492  *	the 3rd (last) one must not have this flag set. The flag is used to
1493  *	deal with retransmission/duplication recovery properly since A-MSDU
1494  *	subframes share the same sequence number. Reported subframes can be
1495  *	either regular MSDU or singly A-MSDUs. Subframes must not be
1496  *	interleaved with other frames.
1497  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END: This frame contains radiotap TLVs in the
1498  *	skb->data (before the 802.11 header).
1499  *	If used, the SKB's mac_header pointer must be set to point
1500  *	to the 802.11 header after the TLVs, and any padding added after TLV
1501  *	data to align to 4 must be cleared by the driver putting the TLVs
1502  *	in the skb.
1503  * @RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN: Allow the same PN as same packet before.
1504  *	This is used for AMSDU subframes which can have the same PN as
1505  *	the first subframe.
1506  * @RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED: The ICV is stripped from this frame. CRC checking must
1507  *	be done in the hardware.
1508  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT: Value of the EOF bit in the A-MPDU delimiter for this
1509  *	frame
1510  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN: The EOF value is known
1511  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE: HE radiotap data is present
1512  *	(&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he, mac80211 will fill in
1513  *
1514  *	 - DATA3_DATA_MCS
1515  *	 - DATA3_DATA_DCM
1516  *	 - DATA3_CODING
1517  *	 - DATA5_GI
1518  *	 - DATA5_DATA_BW_RU_ALLOC
1519  *	 - DATA6_NSTS
1520  *	 - DATA3_STBC
1521  *
1522  *	from the RX info data, so leave those zeroed when building this data)
1523  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU: HE MU radiotap data is present
1524  *	(&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he_mu)
1525  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG: L-SIG radiotap data is present
1526  * @RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU: use the frame only for radiotap reporting, with
1527  *	the "0-length PSDU" field included there.  The value for it is
1528  *	in &struct ieee80211_rx_status.  Note that if this value isn't
1529  *	known the frame shouldn't be reported.
1530  * @RX_FLAG_8023: the frame has an 802.3 header (decap offload performed by
1531  *	hardware or driver)
1532  */
1533 enum mac80211_rx_flags {
1534 	RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR		= BIT(0),
1535 	RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED		= BIT(1),
1536 	RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR		= BIT(2),
1537 	RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED		= BIT(3),
1538 	RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED		= BIT(4),
1539 	RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC		= BIT(5),
1540 	RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC 	= BIT(6),
1541 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_IS_RTAP_TS64	= BIT(7),
1542 	RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL		= BIT(8),
1543 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS		= BIT(9),
1544 	RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED		= BIT(10),
1545 	RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED		= BIT(11),
1546 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN	= BIT(12),
1547 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST		= BIT(13),
1548 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR	= BIT(14),
1549 	/* one free bit at 15 */
1550 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME			= BIT(16) | BIT(17),
1551 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START	= 1 << 16,
1552 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START		= 2 << 16,
1553 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END		= 3 << 16,
1554 	RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR		= BIT(18),
1555 	RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE		= BIT(19),
1556 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END	= BIT(20),
1557 	RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED		= BIT(21),
1558 	RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN		= BIT(22),
1559 	RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED		= BIT(23),
1560 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT		= BIT(24),
1561 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN	= BIT(25),
1562 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE		= BIT(26),
1563 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU		= BIT(27),
1564 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG		= BIT(28),
1565 	RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU			= BIT(29),
1566 	RX_FLAG_8023			= BIT(30),
1567 };
1568 
1569 /**
1570  * enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags - MCS & bandwidth flags
1571  *
1572  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE: Short preamble was used for this frame
1573  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI: Short guard interval was used
1574  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF: This frame was received in a HT-greenfield transmission,
1575  *	if the driver fills this value it should add
1576  *	%IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_FMT
1577  *	to @hw.radiotap_mcs_details to advertise that fact.
1578  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC: LDPC was used
1579  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK: STBC 2 bit bitmask. 1 - Nss=1, 2 - Nss=2, 3 - Nss=3
1580  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_BF: packet was beamformed
1581  */
1582 enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags {
1583 	RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE		= BIT(0),
1584 	RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI		= BIT(2),
1585 	RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF		= BIT(3),
1586 	RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK		= BIT(4) | BIT(5),
1587 	RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC		= BIT(6),
1588 	RX_ENC_FLAG_BF			= BIT(7),
1589 };
1590 
1591 #define RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_SHIFT		4
1592 
1593 enum mac80211_rx_encoding {
1594 	RX_ENC_LEGACY = 0,
1595 	RX_ENC_HT,
1596 	RX_ENC_VHT,
1597 	RX_ENC_HE,
1598 	RX_ENC_EHT,
1599 };
1600 
1601 /**
1602  * struct ieee80211_rx_status - receive status
1603  *
1604  * The low-level driver should provide this information (the subset
1605  * supported by hardware) to the 802.11 code with each received
1606  * frame, in the skb's control buffer (cb).
1607  *
1608  * @mactime: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization Function
1609  * 	(TSF) timer when the first data symbol (MPDU) arrived at the hardware.
1610  * @boottime_ns: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp the frame was received at, this is
1611  *	needed only for beacons and probe responses that update the scan cache.
1612  * @ack_tx_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp for the ack TX in nanoseconds. Only
1613  *	needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action frames.
1614  *	Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1615  * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, mac80211 doesn't use
1616  *	it but can store it and pass it back to the driver for synchronisation
1617  * @band: the active band when this frame was received
1618  * @freq: frequency the radio was tuned to when receiving this frame, in MHz
1619  *	This field must be set for management frames, but isn't strictly needed
1620  *	for data (other) frames - for those it only affects radiotap reporting.
1621  * @freq_offset: @freq has a positive offset of 500Khz.
1622  * @signal: signal strength when receiving this frame, either in dBm, in dB or
1623  *	unspecified depending on the hardware capabilities flags
1624  *	@IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_*
1625  * @chains: bitmask of receive chains for which separate signal strength
1626  *	values were filled.
1627  * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength, in dBm (unlike @signal, doesn't
1628  *	support dB or unspecified units)
1629  * @antenna: antenna used
1630  * @rate_idx: index of data rate into band's supported rates or MCS index if
1631  *	HT or VHT is used (%RX_FLAG_HT/%RX_FLAG_VHT)
1632  * @nss: number of streams (VHT, HE and EHT only)
1633  * @flag: %RX_FLAG_\*
1634  * @encoding: &enum mac80211_rx_encoding
1635  * @bw: &enum rate_info_bw
1636  * @enc_flags: uses bits from &enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags
1637  * @he_ru: HE RU, from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc
1638  * @he_gi: HE GI, from &enum nl80211_he_gi
1639  * @he_dcm: HE DCM value
1640  * @eht: EHT specific rate information
1641  * @eht.ru: EHT RU, from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc
1642  * @eht.gi: EHT GI, from &enum nl80211_eht_gi
1643  * @rx_flags: internal RX flags for mac80211
1644  * @ampdu_reference: A-MPDU reference number, must be a different value for
1645  *	each A-MPDU but the same for each subframe within one A-MPDU
1646  * @zero_length_psdu_type: radiotap type of the 0-length PSDU
1647  * @link_valid: if the link which is identified by @link_id is valid. This flag
1648  *	is set only when connection is MLO.
1649  * @link_id: id of the link used to receive the packet. This is used along with
1650  *	@link_valid.
1651  */
1652 struct ieee80211_rx_status {
1653 	u64 mactime;
1654 	union {
1655 		u64 boottime_ns;
1656 		ktime_t ack_tx_hwtstamp;
1657 	};
1658 	u32 device_timestamp;
1659 	u32 ampdu_reference;
1660 	u32 flag;
1661 	u16 freq: 13, freq_offset: 1;
1662 	u8 enc_flags;
1663 	u8 encoding:3, bw:4;
1664 	union {
1665 		struct {
1666 			u8 he_ru:3;
1667 			u8 he_gi:2;
1668 			u8 he_dcm:1;
1669 		};
1670 		struct {
1671 			u8 ru:4;
1672 			u8 gi:2;
1673 		} eht;
1674 	};
1675 	u8 rate_idx;
1676 	u8 nss;
1677 	u8 rx_flags;
1678 	u8 band;
1679 	u8 antenna;
1680 	s8 signal;
1681 	u8 chains;
1682 	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
1683 	u8 zero_length_psdu_type;
1684 	u8 link_valid:1, link_id:4;
1685 };
1686 
1687 static inline u32
ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status * rx_status)1688 ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status *rx_status)
1689 {
1690 	return MHZ_TO_KHZ(rx_status->freq) +
1691 	       (rx_status->freq_offset ? 500 : 0);
1692 }
1693 
1694 /**
1695  * enum ieee80211_conf_flags - configuration flags
1696  *
1697  * Flags to define PHY configuration options
1698  *
1699  * @IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR: there's a monitor interface present -- use this
1700  *	to determine for example whether to calculate timestamps for packets
1701  *	or not, do not use instead of filter flags!
1702  * @IEEE80211_CONF_PS: Enable 802.11 power save mode (managed mode only).
1703  *	This is the power save mode defined by IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2,
1704  *	meaning that the hardware still wakes up for beacons, is able to
1705  *	transmit frames and receive the possible acknowledgment frames.
1706  *	Not to be confused with hardware specific wakeup/sleep states,
1707  *	driver is responsible for that. See the section "Powersave support"
1708  *	for more.
1709  * @IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE: The device is running, but idle; if the flag is set
1710  *	the driver should be prepared to handle configuration requests but
1711  *	may turn the device off as much as possible. Typically, this flag will
1712  *	be set when an interface is set UP but not associated or scanning, but
1713  *	it can also be unset in that case when monitor interfaces are active.
1714  * @IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL: The device is currently not on its main
1715  *	operating channel.
1716  */
1717 enum ieee80211_conf_flags {
1718 	IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR		= (1<<0),
1719 	IEEE80211_CONF_PS		= (1<<1),
1720 	IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE		= (1<<2),
1721 	IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL	= (1<<3),
1722 };
1723 
1724 
1725 /**
1726  * enum ieee80211_conf_changed - denotes which configuration changed
1727  *
1728  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL: the listen interval changed
1729  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR: the monitor flag changed
1730  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS: the PS flag or dynamic PS timeout changed
1731  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER: the TX power changed
1732  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL: the channel/channel_type changed
1733  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS: retry limits changed
1734  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE: Idle flag changed
1735  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS: Spatial multiplexing powersave mode changed
1736  *	Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1737  *	otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1738  */
1739 enum ieee80211_conf_changed {
1740 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS		= BIT(1),
1741 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL	= BIT(2),
1742 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR		= BIT(3),
1743 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS		= BIT(4),
1744 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER		= BIT(5),
1745 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL		= BIT(6),
1746 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS	= BIT(7),
1747 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE		= BIT(8),
1748 };
1749 
1750 /**
1751  * enum ieee80211_smps_mode - spatial multiplexing power save mode
1752  *
1753  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC: automatic
1754  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF: off
1755  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC: static
1756  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic
1757  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES: internal, don't use
1758  */
1759 enum ieee80211_smps_mode {
1760 	IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC,
1761 	IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF,
1762 	IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC,
1763 	IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC,
1764 
1765 	/* keep last */
1766 	IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES,
1767 };
1768 
1769 /**
1770  * struct ieee80211_conf - configuration of the device
1771  *
1772  * This struct indicates how the driver shall configure the hardware.
1773  *
1774  * @flags: configuration flags defined above
1775  *
1776  * @listen_interval: listen interval in units of beacon interval
1777  * @ps_dtim_period: The DTIM period of the AP we're connected to, for use
1778  *	in power saving. Power saving will not be enabled until a beacon
1779  *	has been received and the DTIM period is known.
1780  * @dynamic_ps_timeout: The dynamic powersave timeout (in ms), see the
1781  *	powersave documentation below. This variable is valid only when
1782  *	the CONF_PS flag is set.
1783  *
1784  * @power_level: requested transmit power (in dBm), backward compatibility
1785  *	value only that is set to the minimum of all interfaces
1786  *
1787  * @chandef: the channel definition to tune to
1788  * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled
1789  *
1790  * @long_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "long" frame
1791  *	(a frame not RTS protected), called "dot11LongRetryLimit" in 802.11,
1792  *	but actually means the number of transmissions not the number of retries
1793  * @short_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "short"
1794  *	frame, called "dot11ShortRetryLimit" in 802.11, but actually means the
1795  *	number of transmissions not the number of retries
1796  *
1797  * @smps_mode: spatial multiplexing powersave mode; note that
1798  *	%IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC is used when the device is not
1799  *	configured for an HT channel.
1800  *	Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1801  *	otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1802  */
1803 struct ieee80211_conf {
1804 	u32 flags;
1805 	int power_level, dynamic_ps_timeout;
1806 
1807 	u16 listen_interval;
1808 	u8 ps_dtim_period;
1809 
1810 	u8 long_frame_max_tx_count, short_frame_max_tx_count;
1811 
1812 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1813 	bool radar_enabled;
1814 	enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1815 };
1816 
1817 /**
1818  * struct ieee80211_channel_switch - holds the channel switch data
1819  *
1820  * The information provided in this structure is required for channel switch
1821  * operation.
1822  *
1823  * @timestamp: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization
1824  *	Function (TSF) timer when the frame containing the channel switch
1825  *	announcement was received. This is simply the rx.mactime parameter
1826  *	the driver passed into mac80211.
1827  * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, this is the
1828  *	rx.device_timestamp parameter the driver passed to mac80211.
1829  * @block_tx: Indicates whether transmission must be blocked before the
1830  *	scheduled channel switch, as indicated by the AP.
1831  * @chandef: the new channel to switch to
1832  * @count: the number of TBTT's until the channel switch event
1833  * @delay: maximum delay between the time the AP transmitted the last beacon in
1834  *	current channel and the expected time of the first beacon in the new
1835  *	channel, expressed in TU.
1836  * @link_id: the link ID of the link doing the channel switch, 0 for non-MLO
1837  */
1838 struct ieee80211_channel_switch {
1839 	u64 timestamp;
1840 	u32 device_timestamp;
1841 	bool block_tx;
1842 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1843 	u8 count;
1844 	u8 link_id;
1845 	u32 delay;
1846 };
1847 
1848 /**
1849  * enum ieee80211_vif_flags - virtual interface flags
1850  *
1851  * @IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER: the device performs beacon filtering
1852  *	on this virtual interface to avoid unnecessary CPU wakeups
1853  * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI: the device can do connection quality
1854  *	monitoring on this virtual interface -- i.e. it can monitor
1855  *	connection quality related parameters, such as the RSSI level and
1856  *	provide notifications if configured trigger levels are reached.
1857  * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD: The device can do U-APSD for this
1858  *	interface. This flag should be set during interface addition,
1859  *	but may be set/cleared as late as authentication to an AP. It is
1860  *	only valid for managed/station mode interfaces.
1861  * @IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE: request to handle NOA attributes
1862  *	and send P2P_PS notification to the driver if NOA changed, even
1863  *	this is not pure P2P vif.
1864  * @IEEE80211_VIF_EML_ACTIVE: The driver indicates that EML operation is
1865  *      enabled for the interface.
1866  * @IEEE80211_VIF_IGNORE_OFDMA_WIDER_BW: Ignore wider bandwidth OFDMA
1867  *	operation on this interface and request a channel context without
1868  *	the AP definition. Use this e.g. because the device is able to
1869  *	handle OFDMA (downlink and trigger for uplink) on a per-AP basis.
1870  * @IEEE80211_VIF_REMOVE_AP_AFTER_DISASSOC: indicates that the AP sta should
1871  *	be removed only after setting the vif as unassociated, and not the
1872  *	opposite. Only relevant for STA vifs.
1873  */
1874 enum ieee80211_vif_flags {
1875 	IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER		= BIT(0),
1876 	IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI		= BIT(1),
1877 	IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD		= BIT(2),
1878 	IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE		= BIT(3),
1879 	IEEE80211_VIF_EML_ACTIVE	        = BIT(4),
1880 	IEEE80211_VIF_IGNORE_OFDMA_WIDER_BW	= BIT(5),
1881 	IEEE80211_VIF_REMOVE_AP_AFTER_DISASSOC	= BIT(6),
1882 };
1883 
1884 
1885 /**
1886  * enum ieee80211_offload_flags - virtual interface offload flags
1887  *
1888  * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED: tx encapsulation offload is enabled
1889  *	The driver supports sending frames passed as 802.3 frames by mac80211.
1890  *	It must also support sending 802.11 packets for the same interface.
1891  * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR: support 4-address mode encapsulation offload
1892  * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED: rx encapsulation offload is enabled
1893  *	The driver supports passing received 802.11 frames as 802.3 frames to
1894  *	mac80211.
1895  */
1896 
1897 enum ieee80211_offload_flags {
1898 	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED		= BIT(0),
1899 	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR		= BIT(1),
1900 	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED		= BIT(2),
1901 };
1902 
1903 /**
1904  * struct ieee80211_vif_cfg - interface configuration
1905  * @assoc: association status
1906  * @ibss_joined: indicates whether this station is part of an IBSS or not
1907  * @ibss_creator: indicates if a new IBSS network is being created
1908  * @ps: power-save mode (STA only). This flag is NOT affected by
1909  *	offchannel/dynamic_ps operations.
1910  * @aid: association ID number, valid only when @assoc is true
1911  * @eml_cap: EML capabilities as described in P802.11be_D4.1 Figure 9-1001j.
1912  * @eml_med_sync_delay: Medium Synchronization delay as described in
1913  *	P802.11be_D4.1 Figure 9-1001i.
1914  * @mld_capa_op: MLD Capabilities and Operations per P802.11be_D4.1
1915  *	Figure 9-1001k
1916  * @arp_addr_list: List of IPv4 addresses for hardware ARP filtering. The
1917  *	may filter ARP queries targeted for other addresses than listed here.
1918  *	The driver must allow ARP queries targeted for all address listed here
1919  *	to pass through. An empty list implies no ARP queries need to pass.
1920  * @arp_addr_cnt: Number of addresses currently on the list. Note that this
1921  *	may be larger than %IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN (the arp_addr_list
1922  *	array size), it's up to the driver what to do in that case.
1923  * @ssid: The SSID of the current vif. Valid in AP and IBSS mode.
1924  * @ssid_len: Length of SSID given in @ssid.
1925  * @s1g: BSS is S1G BSS (affects Association Request format).
1926  * @idle: This interface is idle. There's also a global idle flag in the
1927  *	hardware config which may be more appropriate depending on what
1928  *	your driver/device needs to do.
1929  * @ap_addr: AP MLD address, or BSSID for non-MLO connections
1930  *	(station mode only)
1931  */
1932 struct ieee80211_vif_cfg {
1933 	/* association related data */
1934 	bool assoc, ibss_joined;
1935 	bool ibss_creator;
1936 	bool ps;
1937 	u16 aid;
1938 	u16 eml_cap;
1939 	u16 eml_med_sync_delay;
1940 	u16 mld_capa_op;
1941 
1942 	__be32 arp_addr_list[IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN];
1943 	int arp_addr_cnt;
1944 	u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
1945 	size_t ssid_len;
1946 	bool s1g;
1947 	bool idle;
1948 	u8 ap_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1949 };
1950 
1951 #define IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS 8
1952 
1953 /**
1954  * struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm - negotiated TID to link map info
1955  *
1956  * @downlink: bitmap of active links per TID for downlink, or 0 if mapping for
1957  *	this TID is not included.
1958  * @uplink: bitmap of active links per TID for uplink, or 0 if mapping for this
1959  *	TID is not included.
1960  * @valid: info is valid or not.
1961  */
1962 struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm {
1963 	u16 downlink[IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS];
1964 	u16 uplink[IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS];
1965 	bool valid;
1966 };
1967 
1968 /**
1969  * enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res - return value for negotiated TTLM handling
1970  * @NEG_TTLM_RES_ACCEPT: accept the request
1971  * @NEG_TTLM_RES_REJECT: reject the request
1972  * @NEG_TTLM_RES_SUGGEST_PREFERRED: reject and suggest a new mapping
1973  */
1974 enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res {
1975 	NEG_TTLM_RES_ACCEPT,
1976 	NEG_TTLM_RES_REJECT,
1977 	NEG_TTLM_RES_SUGGEST_PREFERRED
1978 };
1979 
1980 /**
1981  * struct ieee80211_vif - per-interface data
1982  *
1983  * Data in this structure is continually present for driver
1984  * use during the life of a virtual interface.
1985  *
1986  * @type: type of this virtual interface
1987  * @cfg: vif configuration, see &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg
1988  * @bss_conf: BSS configuration for this interface, either our own
1989  *	or the BSS we're associated to
1990  * @link_conf: in case of MLD, the per-link BSS configuration,
1991  *	indexed by link ID
1992  * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1993  * @active_links: The bitmap of active links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1994  *	The driver shouldn't change this directly, but use the
1995  *	API calls meant for that purpose.
1996  * @dormant_links: subset of the valid links that are disabled/suspended
1997  *	due to advertised or negotiated TTLM respectively.
1998  *	0 for non-MLO.
1999  * @suspended_links: subset of dormant_links representing links that are
2000  *	suspended due to negotiated TTLM, and could be activated in the
2001  *	future by tearing down the TTLM negotiation.
2002  *	0 for non-MLO.
2003  * @neg_ttlm: negotiated TID to link mapping info.
2004  *	see &struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm.
2005  * @addr: address of this interface
2006  * @addr_valid: indicates if the address is actively used. Set to false for
2007  *	passive monitor interfaces, true in all other cases.
2008  * @p2p: indicates whether this AP or STA interface is a p2p
2009  *	interface, i.e. a GO or p2p-sta respectively
2010  * @netdev_features: tx netdev features supported by the hardware for this
2011  *	vif. mac80211 initializes this to hw->netdev_features, and the driver
2012  *	can mask out specific tx features. mac80211 will handle software fixup
2013  *	for masked offloads (GSO, CSUM)
2014  * @driver_flags: flags/capabilities the driver has for this interface,
2015  *	these need to be set (or cleared) when the interface is added
2016  *	or, if supported by the driver, the interface type is changed
2017  *	at runtime, mac80211 will never touch this field
2018  * @offload_flags: hardware offload capabilities/flags for this interface.
2019  *	These are initialized by mac80211 before calling .add_interface,
2020  *	.change_interface or .update_vif_offload and updated by the driver
2021  *	within these ops, based on supported features or runtime change
2022  *	restrictions.
2023  * @hw_queue: hardware queue for each AC
2024  * @cab_queue: content-after-beacon (DTIM beacon really) queue, AP mode only
2025  * @debugfs_dir: debugfs dentry, can be used by drivers to create own per
2026  *	interface debug files. Note that it will be NULL for the virtual
2027  *	monitor interface (if that is requested.)
2028  * @probe_req_reg: probe requests should be reported to mac80211 for this
2029  *	interface.
2030  * @rx_mcast_action_reg: multicast Action frames should be reported to mac80211
2031  *	for this interface.
2032  * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
2033  *	sizeof(void \*).
2034  * @txq: the multicast data TX queue
2035  * @offload_flags: 802.3 -> 802.11 enapsulation offload flags, see
2036  *	&enum ieee80211_offload_flags.
2037  */
2038 struct ieee80211_vif {
2039 	enum nl80211_iftype type;
2040 	struct ieee80211_vif_cfg cfg;
2041 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf bss_conf;
2042 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf __rcu *link_conf[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
2043 	u16 valid_links, active_links, dormant_links, suspended_links;
2044 	struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm neg_ttlm;
2045 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2046 	bool addr_valid;
2047 	bool p2p;
2048 
2049 	u8 cab_queue;
2050 	u8 hw_queue[IEEE80211_NUM_ACS];
2051 
2052 	struct ieee80211_txq *txq;
2053 
2054 	netdev_features_t netdev_features;
2055 	u32 driver_flags;
2056 	u32 offload_flags;
2057 
2058 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
2059 	struct dentry *debugfs_dir;
2060 #endif
2061 
2062 	bool probe_req_reg;
2063 	bool rx_mcast_action_reg;
2064 
2065 	/* must be last */
2066 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2067 };
2068 
2069 /**
2070  * ieee80211_vif_usable_links - Return the usable links for the vif
2071  * @vif: the vif for which the usable links are requested
2072  * Return: the usable link bitmap
2073  */
ieee80211_vif_usable_links(const struct ieee80211_vif * vif)2074 static inline u16 ieee80211_vif_usable_links(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2075 {
2076 	return vif->valid_links & ~vif->dormant_links;
2077 }
2078 
2079 /**
2080  * ieee80211_vif_is_mld - Returns true iff the vif is an MLD one
2081  * @vif: the vif
2082  * Return: %true if the vif is an MLD, %false otherwise.
2083  */
ieee80211_vif_is_mld(const struct ieee80211_vif * vif)2084 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mld(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2085 {
2086 	/* valid_links != 0 indicates this vif is an MLD */
2087 	return vif->valid_links != 0;
2088 }
2089 
2090 /**
2091  * ieee80211_vif_link_active - check if a given link is active
2092  * @vif: the vif
2093  * @link_id: the link ID to check
2094  * Return: %true if the vif is an MLD and the link is active, or if
2095  *	the vif is not an MLD and the link ID is 0; %false otherwise.
2096  */
ieee80211_vif_link_active(const struct ieee80211_vif * vif,unsigned int link_id)2097 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_link_active(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
2098 					     unsigned int link_id)
2099 {
2100 	if (!ieee80211_vif_is_mld(vif))
2101 		return link_id == 0;
2102 	return vif->active_links & BIT(link_id);
2103 }
2104 
2105 #define for_each_vif_active_link(vif, link, link_id)				\
2106 	for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((vif)->link_conf); link_id++)	\
2107 		if ((!(vif)->active_links ||					\
2108 		     (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) &&			\
2109 		    (link = link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id)))
2110 
ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif * vif)2111 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2112 {
2113 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_MESH
2114 	return vif->type == NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT;
2115 #endif
2116 	return false;
2117 }
2118 
2119 /**
2120  * wdev_to_ieee80211_vif - return a vif struct from a wdev
2121  * @wdev: the wdev to get the vif for
2122  *
2123  * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
2124  * (like the vendor commands) that get a wdev.
2125  *
2126  * Return: pointer to the wdev, or %NULL if the given wdev isn't
2127  * associated with a vif that the driver knows about (e.g. monitor
2128  * or AP_VLAN interfaces.)
2129  */
2130 struct ieee80211_vif *wdev_to_ieee80211_vif(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
2131 
2132 /**
2133  * ieee80211_vif_to_wdev - return a wdev struct from a vif
2134  * @vif: the vif to get the wdev for
2135  *
2136  * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
2137  * (like the vendor commands) that needs to get the wdev for a vif.
2138  * This can also be useful to get the netdev associated to a vif.
2139  *
2140  * Return: pointer to the wdev
2141  */
2142 struct wireless_dev *ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
2143 
lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_vif * vif)2144 static inline bool lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2145 {
2146 	return lockdep_is_held(&ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(vif)->wiphy->mtx);
2147 }
2148 
2149 #define link_conf_dereference_protected(vif, link_id)		\
2150 	rcu_dereference_protected((vif)->link_conf[link_id],	\
2151 				  lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(vif))
2152 
2153 #define link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id)		\
2154 	rcu_dereference_check((vif)->link_conf[link_id],	\
2155 			      lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(vif))
2156 
2157 /**
2158  * enum ieee80211_key_flags - key flags
2159  *
2160  * These flags are used for communication about keys between the driver
2161  * and mac80211, with the @flags parameter of &struct ieee80211_key_conf.
2162  *
2163  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV: This flag should be set by the
2164  *	driver to indicate that it requires IV generation for this
2165  *	particular key. Setting this flag does not necessarily mean that SKBs
2166  *	will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or MIC.
2167  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC: This flag should be set by
2168  *	the driver for a TKIP key if it requires Michael MIC
2169  *	generation in software.
2170  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE: Set by mac80211, this flag indicates
2171  *	that the key is pairwise rather then a shared key.
2172  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX: This flag should be set by the driver for a
2173  *	CCMP/GCMP key if it requires CCMP/GCMP encryption of management frames
2174  *	(MFP) to be done in software.
2175  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver
2176  *	if space should be prepared for the IV, but the IV
2177  *	itself should not be generated. Do not set together with
2178  *	@IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV on the same key. Setting this flag does
2179  *	not necessarily mean that SKBs will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or
2180  *	MIC.
2181  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT: This key will be used to decrypt received
2182  *	management frames. The flag can help drivers that have a hardware
2183  *	crypto implementation that doesn't deal with management frames
2184  *	properly by allowing them to not upload the keys to hardware and
2185  *	fall back to software crypto. Note that this flag deals only with
2186  *	RX, if your crypto engine can't deal with TX you can also set the
2187  *	%IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX flag to encrypt such frames in SW.
2188  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT: This flag should be set by the
2189  *	driver for a CCMP/GCMP key to indicate that is requires IV generation
2190  *	only for management frames (MFP).
2191  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM: This flag should be set by the
2192  *	driver for a key to indicate that sufficient tailroom must always
2193  *	be reserved for ICV or MIC, even when HW encryption is enabled.
2194  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver for
2195  *	a TKIP key if it only requires MIC space. Do not set together with
2196  *	@IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC on the same key.
2197  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX: Key needs explicit Tx activation.
2198  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE: This flag should be set by the driver
2199  *	for a AES_CMAC or a AES_GMAC key to indicate that it requires sequence
2200  *	number generation only
2201  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SPP_AMSDU: SPP A-MSDUs can be used with this key
2202  *	(set by mac80211 from the sta->spp_amsdu flag)
2203  */
2204 enum ieee80211_key_flags {
2205 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT	= BIT(0),
2206 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV		= BIT(1),
2207 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC	= BIT(2),
2208 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE		= BIT(3),
2209 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX		= BIT(4),
2210 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE		= BIT(5),
2211 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT		= BIT(6),
2212 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM	= BIT(7),
2213 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE	= BIT(8),
2214 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX		= BIT(9),
2215 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE	= BIT(10),
2216 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SPP_AMSDU		= BIT(11),
2217 };
2218 
2219 /**
2220  * struct ieee80211_key_conf - key information
2221  *
2222  * This key information is given by mac80211 to the driver by
2223  * the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops.
2224  *
2225  * @hw_key_idx: To be set by the driver, this is the key index the driver
2226  *	wants to be given when a frame is transmitted and needs to be
2227  *	encrypted in hardware.
2228  * @cipher: The key's cipher suite selector.
2229  * @tx_pn: PN used for TX keys, may be used by the driver as well if it
2230  *	needs to do software PN assignment by itself (e.g. due to TSO)
2231  * @flags: key flags, see &enum ieee80211_key_flags.
2232  * @keyidx: the key index (0-7)
2233  * @keylen: key material length
2234  * @key: key material. For ALG_TKIP the key is encoded as a 256-bit (32 byte)
2235  * 	data block:
2236  * 	- Temporal Encryption Key (128 bits)
2237  * 	- Temporal Authenticator Tx MIC Key (64 bits)
2238  * 	- Temporal Authenticator Rx MIC Key (64 bits)
2239  * @icv_len: The ICV length for this key type
2240  * @iv_len: The IV length for this key type
2241  * @link_id: the link ID, 0 for non-MLO, or -1 for pairwise keys
2242  */
2243 struct ieee80211_key_conf {
2244 	atomic64_t tx_pn;
2245 	u32 cipher;
2246 	u8 icv_len;
2247 	u8 iv_len;
2248 	u8 hw_key_idx;
2249 	s8 keyidx;
2250 	u16 flags;
2251 	s8 link_id;
2252 	u8 keylen;
2253 	u8 key[];
2254 };
2255 
2256 #define IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN	16
2257 
2258 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV16(pn) ((u16)(pn & 0xffff))
2259 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV32(pn) ((u32)((pn >> 16) & 0xffffffff))
2260 
2261 /**
2262  * struct ieee80211_key_seq - key sequence counter
2263  *
2264  * @tkip: TKIP data, containing IV32 and IV16 in host byte order
2265  * @ccmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2266  *	reverse order than in packet)
2267  * @aes_cmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2268  *	reverse order than in packet)
2269  * @aes_gmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2270  *	reverse order than in packet)
2271  * @gcmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2272  *	reverse order than in packet)
2273  * @hw: data for HW-only (e.g. cipher scheme) keys
2274  */
2275 struct ieee80211_key_seq {
2276 	union {
2277 		struct {
2278 			u32 iv32;
2279 			u16 iv16;
2280 		} tkip;
2281 		struct {
2282 			u8 pn[6];
2283 		} ccmp;
2284 		struct {
2285 			u8 pn[6];
2286 		} aes_cmac;
2287 		struct {
2288 			u8 pn[6];
2289 		} aes_gmac;
2290 		struct {
2291 			u8 pn[6];
2292 		} gcmp;
2293 		struct {
2294 			u8 seq[IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN];
2295 			u8 seq_len;
2296 		} hw;
2297 	};
2298 };
2299 
2300 /**
2301  * enum set_key_cmd - key command
2302  *
2303  * Used with the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2304  * indicates whether a key is being removed or added.
2305  *
2306  * @SET_KEY: a key is set
2307  * @DISABLE_KEY: a key must be disabled
2308  */
2309 enum set_key_cmd {
2310 	SET_KEY, DISABLE_KEY,
2311 };
2312 
2313 /**
2314  * enum ieee80211_sta_state - station state
2315  *
2316  * @IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST: station doesn't exist at all,
2317  *	this is a special state for add/remove transitions
2318  * @IEEE80211_STA_NONE: station exists without special state
2319  * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTH: station is authenticated
2320  * @IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC: station is associated
2321  * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X)
2322  */
2323 enum ieee80211_sta_state {
2324 	/* NOTE: These need to be ordered correctly! */
2325 	IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST,
2326 	IEEE80211_STA_NONE,
2327 	IEEE80211_STA_AUTH,
2328 	IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC,
2329 	IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED,
2330 };
2331 
2332 /**
2333  * enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth - station RX bandwidth
2334  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20: station can only receive 20 MHz
2335  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40: station can receive up to 40 MHz
2336  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80: station can receive up to 80 MHz
2337  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160: station can receive up to 160 MHz
2338  *	(including 80+80 MHz)
2339  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320: station can receive up to 320 MHz
2340  *
2341  * Implementation note: 20 must be zero to be initialized
2342  *	correctly, the values must be sorted.
2343  */
2344 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth {
2345 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20 = 0,
2346 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40,
2347 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80,
2348 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160,
2349 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320,
2350 };
2351 
2352 #define IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_MAX	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320
2353 
2354 /**
2355  * struct ieee80211_sta_rates - station rate selection table
2356  *
2357  * @rcu_head: RCU head used for freeing the table on update
2358  * @rate: transmit rates/flags to be used by default.
2359  *	Overriding entries per-packet is possible by using cb tx control.
2360  */
2361 struct ieee80211_sta_rates {
2362 	struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2363 	struct {
2364 		s8 idx;
2365 		u8 count;
2366 		u8 count_cts;
2367 		u8 count_rts;
2368 		u16 flags;
2369 	} rate[IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE];
2370 };
2371 
2372 /**
2373  * struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration
2374  *
2375  * Used to configure txpower for station.
2376  *
2377  * @power: indicates the tx power, in dBm, to be used when sending data frames
2378  *	to the STA.
2379  * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power
2380  *	will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC
2381  *	%type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power.
2382  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for
2383  *	per peer TPC.
2384  */
2385 struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr {
2386 	s16 power;
2387 	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type;
2388 };
2389 
2390 /**
2391  * struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates - info that is aggregated from active links
2392  *
2393  * Used for any per-link data that needs to be aggregated and updated in the
2394  * main &struct ieee80211_sta when updated or the active links change.
2395  *
2396  * @max_amsdu_len: indicates the maximal length of an A-MSDU in bytes.
2397  *	This field is always valid for packets with a VHT preamble.
2398  *	For packets with a HT preamble, additional limits apply:
2399  *
2400  *	* If the skb is transmitted as part of a BA agreement, the
2401  *	  A-MSDU maximal size is min(max_amsdu_len, 4065) bytes.
2402  *	* If the skb is not part of a BA agreement, the A-MSDU maximal
2403  *	  size is min(max_amsdu_len, 7935) bytes.
2404  *
2405  * Both additional HT limits must be enforced by the low level
2406  * driver. This is defined by the spec (IEEE 802.11-2012 section
2407  * 8.3.2.2 NOTE 2).
2408  * @max_rc_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes recommended by rate control.
2409  * @max_tid_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes for this TID
2410  */
2411 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates {
2412 	u16 max_amsdu_len;
2413 
2414 	u16 max_rc_amsdu_len;
2415 	u16 max_tid_amsdu_len[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS];
2416 };
2417 
2418 /**
2419  * struct ieee80211_link_sta - station Link specific info
2420  * All link specific info for a STA link for a non MLD STA(single)
2421  * or a MLD STA(multiple entries) are stored here.
2422  *
2423  * @sta: reference to owning STA
2424  * @addr: MAC address of the Link STA. For non-MLO STA this is same as the addr
2425  *	in ieee80211_sta. For MLO Link STA this addr can be same or different
2426  *	from addr in ieee80211_sta (representing MLD STA addr)
2427  * @link_id: the link ID for this link STA (0 for deflink)
2428  * @smps_mode: current SMPS mode (off, static or dynamic)
2429  * @supp_rates: Bitmap of supported rates
2430  * @ht_cap: HT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2431  * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2432  * @he_cap: HE capabilities of this STA
2433  * @he_6ghz_capa: on 6 GHz, holds the HE 6 GHz band capabilities
2434  * @eht_cap: EHT capabilities of this STA
2435  * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities of this STA
2436  * @agg: per-link data for multi-link aggregation
2437  * @bandwidth: current bandwidth the station can receive with
2438  * @rx_nss: in HT/VHT, the maximum number of spatial streams the
2439  *	station can receive at the moment, changed by operating mode
2440  *	notifications and capabilities. The value is only valid after
2441  *	the station moves to associated state.
2442  * @txpwr: the station tx power configuration
2443  *
2444  */
2445 struct ieee80211_link_sta {
2446 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2447 
2448 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
2449 	u8 link_id;
2450 	enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
2451 
2452 	u32 supp_rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2453 	struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
2454 	struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
2455 	struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap;
2456 	struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa;
2457 	struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap eht_cap;
2458 	struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap s1g_cap;
2459 
2460 	struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates agg;
2461 
2462 	u8 rx_nss;
2463 	enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth bandwidth;
2464 	struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr txpwr;
2465 };
2466 
2467 /**
2468  * struct ieee80211_sta - station table entry
2469  *
2470  * A station table entry represents a station we are possibly
2471  * communicating with. Since stations are RCU-managed in
2472  * mac80211, any ieee80211_sta pointer you get access to must
2473  * either be protected by rcu_read_lock() explicitly or implicitly,
2474  * or you must take good care to not use such a pointer after a
2475  * call to your sta_remove callback that removed it.
2476  * This also represents the MLD STA in case of MLO association
2477  * and holds pointers to various link STA's
2478  *
2479  * @addr: MAC address
2480  * @aid: AID we assigned to the station if we're an AP
2481  * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximal amount of frames in a single AMPDU
2482  *	that this station is allowed to transmit to us.
2483  *	Can be modified by driver.
2484  * @wme: indicates whether the STA supports QoS/WME (if local devices does,
2485  *	otherwise always false)
2486  * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
2487  *	sizeof(void \*), size is determined in hw information.
2488  * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Only valid
2489  *	if wme is supported. The bits order is like in
2490  *	IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_*.
2491  * @max_sp: max Service Period. Only valid if wme is supported.
2492  * @rates: rate control selection table
2493  * @tdls: indicates whether the STA is a TDLS peer
2494  * @tdls_initiator: indicates the STA is an initiator of the TDLS link. Only
2495  *	valid if the STA is a TDLS peer in the first place.
2496  * @mfp: indicates whether the STA uses management frame protection or not.
2497  * @mlo: indicates whether the STA is MLO station.
2498  * @max_amsdu_subframes: indicates the maximal number of MSDUs in a single
2499  *	A-MSDU. Taken from the Extended Capabilities element. 0 means
2500  *	unlimited.
2501  * @eml_cap: EML capabilities of this MLO station
2502  * @cur: currently valid data as aggregated from the active links
2503  *	For non MLO STA it will point to the deflink data. For MLO STA
2504  *	ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates() must be called to update it.
2505  * @support_p2p_ps: indicates whether the STA supports P2P PS mechanism or not.
2506  * @txq: per-TID data TX queues; note that the last entry (%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS)
2507  *	is used for non-data frames
2508  * @deflink: This holds the default link STA information, for non MLO STA all link
2509  *	specific STA information is accessed through @deflink or through
2510  *	link[0] which points to address of @deflink. For MLO Link STA
2511  *	the first added link STA will point to deflink.
2512  * @link: reference to Link Sta entries. For Non MLO STA, except 1st link,
2513  *	i.e link[0] all links would be assigned to NULL by default and
2514  *	would access link information via @deflink or link[0]. For MLO
2515  *	STA, first link STA being added will point its link pointer to
2516  *	@deflink address and remaining would be allocated and the address
2517  *	would be assigned to link[link_id] where link_id is the id assigned
2518  *	by the AP.
2519  * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO
2520  * @spp_amsdu: indicates whether the STA uses SPP A-MSDU or not.
2521  */
2522 struct ieee80211_sta {
2523 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2524 	u16 aid;
2525 	u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
2526 	bool wme;
2527 	u8 uapsd_queues;
2528 	u8 max_sp;
2529 	struct ieee80211_sta_rates __rcu *rates;
2530 	bool tdls;
2531 	bool tdls_initiator;
2532 	bool mfp;
2533 	bool mlo;
2534 	bool spp_amsdu;
2535 	u8 max_amsdu_subframes;
2536 	u16 eml_cap;
2537 
2538 	struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates *cur;
2539 
2540 	bool support_p2p_ps;
2541 
2542 	struct ieee80211_txq *txq[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS + 1];
2543 
2544 	u16 valid_links;
2545 	struct ieee80211_link_sta deflink;
2546 	struct ieee80211_link_sta __rcu *link[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
2547 
2548 	/* must be last */
2549 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2550 };
2551 
2552 #ifdef CONFIG_LOCKDEP
2553 bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
2554 #else
lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta * pubsta)2555 static inline bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta)
2556 {
2557 	return true;
2558 }
2559 #endif
2560 
2561 #define link_sta_dereference_protected(sta, link_id)		\
2562 	rcu_dereference_protected((sta)->link[link_id],		\
2563 				  lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2564 
2565 #define link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id)		\
2566 	rcu_dereference_check((sta)->link[link_id],		\
2567 			      lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2568 
2569 #define for_each_sta_active_link(vif, sta, link_sta, link_id)			\
2570 	for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((sta)->link); link_id++)		\
2571 		if ((!(vif)->active_links ||					\
2572 		     (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) &&			\
2573 		    ((link_sta) = link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id)))
2574 
2575 /**
2576  * enum sta_notify_cmd - sta notify command
2577  *
2578  * Used with the sta_notify() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2579  * indicates if an associated station made a power state transition.
2580  *
2581  * @STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP: a station is now sleeping
2582  * @STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE: a sleeping station woke up
2583  */
2584 enum sta_notify_cmd {
2585 	STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP, STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE,
2586 };
2587 
2588 /**
2589  * struct ieee80211_tx_control - TX control data
2590  *
2591  * @sta: station table entry, this sta pointer may be NULL and
2592  * 	it is not allowed to copy the pointer, due to RCU.
2593  */
2594 struct ieee80211_tx_control {
2595 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2596 };
2597 
2598 /**
2599  * struct ieee80211_txq - Software intermediate tx queue
2600  *
2601  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
2602  * @sta: station table entry, %NULL for per-vif queue
2603  * @tid: the TID for this queue (unused for per-vif queue),
2604  *	%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS for non-data (if enabled)
2605  * @ac: the AC for this queue
2606  * @drv_priv: driver private area, sized by hw->txq_data_size
2607  *
2608  * The driver can obtain packets from this queue by calling
2609  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue().
2610  */
2611 struct ieee80211_txq {
2612 	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
2613 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2614 	u8 tid;
2615 	u8 ac;
2616 
2617 	/* must be last */
2618 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2619 };
2620 
2621 /**
2622  * enum ieee80211_hw_flags - hardware flags
2623  *
2624  * These flags are used to indicate hardware capabilities to
2625  * the stack. Generally, flags here should have their meaning
2626  * done in a way that the simplest hardware doesn't need setting
2627  * any particular flags. There are some exceptions to this rule,
2628  * however, so you are advised to review these flags carefully.
2629  *
2630  * @IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL:
2631  *	The hardware or firmware includes rate control, and cannot be
2632  *	controlled by the stack. As such, no rate control algorithm
2633  *	should be instantiated, and the TX rate reported to userspace
2634  *	will be taken from the TX status instead of the rate control
2635  *	algorithm.
2636  *	Note that this requires that the driver implement a number of
2637  *	callbacks so it has the correct information, it needs to have
2638  *	the @set_rts_threshold callback and must look at the BSS config
2639  *	@use_cts_prot for G/N protection, @use_short_slot for slot
2640  *	timing in 2.4 GHz and @use_short_preamble for preambles for
2641  *	CCK frames.
2642  *
2643  * @IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS:
2644  *	Indicates that received frames passed to the stack include
2645  *	the FCS at the end.
2646  *
2647  * @IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING:
2648  *	Some wireless LAN chipsets buffer broadcast/multicast frames
2649  *	for power saving stations in the hardware/firmware and others
2650  *	rely on the host system for such buffering. This option is used
2651  *	to configure the IEEE 802.11 upper layer to buffer broadcast and
2652  *	multicast frames when there are power saving stations so that
2653  *	the driver can fetch them with ieee80211_get_buffered_bc().
2654  *
2655  * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC:
2656  *	Hardware can provide signal values but we don't know its units. We
2657  *	expect values between 0 and @max_signal.
2658  *	If possible please provide dB or dBm instead.
2659  *
2660  * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM:
2661  *	Hardware gives signal values in dBm, decibel difference from
2662  *	one milliwatt. This is the preferred method since it is standardized
2663  *	between different devices. @max_signal does not need to be set.
2664  *
2665  * @IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT:
2666  * 	Hardware supports spectrum management defined in 802.11h
2667  * 	Measurement, Channel Switch, Quieting, TPC
2668  *
2669  * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION:
2670  *	Hardware supports 11n A-MPDU aggregation.
2671  *
2672  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS:
2673  *	Hardware has power save support (i.e. can go to sleep).
2674  *
2675  * @IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK:
2676  *	Hardware requires nullfunc frame handling in stack, implies
2677  *	stack support for dynamic PS.
2678  *
2679  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS:
2680  *	Hardware has support for dynamic PS.
2681  *
2682  * @IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE:
2683  *	Hardware supports management frame protection (MFP, IEEE 802.11w).
2684  *
2685  * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS:
2686  *	Hardware can provide ack status reports of Tx frames to
2687  *	the stack.
2688  *
2689  * @IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR:
2690  *	The hardware performs its own connection monitoring, including
2691  *	periodic keep-alives to the AP and probing the AP on beacon loss.
2692  *
2693  * @IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC:
2694  *	This device needs to get data from beacon before association (i.e.
2695  *	dtim_period).
2696  *
2697  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK: The device's crypto engine supports
2698  *	per-station GTKs as used by IBSS RSN or during fast transition. If
2699  *	the device doesn't support per-station GTKs, but can be asked not
2700  *	to decrypt group addressed frames, then IBSS RSN support is still
2701  *	possible but software crypto will be used. Advertise the wiphy flag
2702  *	only in that case.
2703  *
2704  * @IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS: When operating in AP mode the device
2705  *	autonomously manages the PS status of connected stations. When
2706  *	this flag is set mac80211 will not trigger PS mode for connected
2707  *	stations based on the PM bit of incoming frames.
2708  *	Use ieee80211_start_ps()/ieee8021_end_ps() to manually configure
2709  *	the PS mode of connected stations.
2710  *
2711  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW: The device handles TX A-MPDU session
2712  *	setup strictly in HW. mac80211 should not attempt to do this in
2713  *	software.
2714  *
2715  * @IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF: The driver would like to be informed of
2716  *	a virtual monitor interface when monitor interfaces are the only
2717  *	active interfaces.
2718  *
2719  * @IEEE80211_HW_NO_VIRTUAL_MONITOR: The driver would like to be informed
2720  *	of any monitor interface, as well as their configured channel.
2721  *	This is useful for supporting multiple monitor interfaces on different
2722  *	channels.
2723  *
2724  * @IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF: The driver would like for no wlanX to
2725  *	be created.  It is expected user-space will create vifs as
2726  *	desired (and thus have them named as desired).
2727  *
2728  * @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL: The driver wants to control which of the
2729  *	crypto algorithms can be done in software - so don't automatically
2730  *	try to fall back to it if hardware crypto fails, but do so only if
2731  *	the driver returns 1. This also forces the driver to advertise its
2732  *	supported cipher suites.
2733  *
2734  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT: The driver/hardware supports fast-xmit,
2735  *	this currently requires only the ability to calculate the duration
2736  *	for frames.
2737  *
2738  * @IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL: The driver wants to control per-interface
2739  *	queue mapping in order to use different queues (not just one per AC)
2740  *	for different virtual interfaces. See the doc section on HW queue
2741  *	control for more details.
2742  *
2743  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE: The driver supports using a rate
2744  *	selection table provided by the rate control algorithm.
2745  *
2746  * @IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF: Use the P2P Device address for any
2747  *	P2P Interface. This will be honoured even if more than one interface
2748  *	is supported.
2749  *
2750  * @IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY: Use sync timing from beacon frames
2751  *	only, to allow getting TBTT of a DTIM beacon.
2752  *
2753  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES: Hardware supports mixing HT/CCK rates
2754  *	and can cope with CCK rates in an aggregation session (e.g. by not
2755  *	using aggregation for such frames.)
2756  *
2757  * @IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA: Support 802.11h based channel-switch (CSA)
2758  *	for a single active channel while using channel contexts. When support
2759  *	is not enabled the default action is to disconnect when getting the
2760  *	CSA frame.
2761  *
2762  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS: The driver will never modify the payload
2763  *	or tailroom of TX skbs without copying them first.
2764  *
2765  * @IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS: The HW supports scanning on all bands
2766  *	in one command, mac80211 doesn't have to run separate scans per band.
2767  *
2768  * @IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW: The device/driver supports wider bandwidth
2769  *	than then BSS bandwidth for a TDLS link on the base channel.
2770  *
2771  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU: The driver supports receiving A-MSDUs
2772  *	within A-MPDU.
2773  *
2774  * @IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS: The device/driver provides TX status
2775  *	for sent beacons.
2776  *
2777  * @IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR: Hardware (or driver) requires that each
2778  *	station has a unique address, i.e. each station entry can be identified
2779  *	by just its MAC address; this prevents, for example, the same station
2780  *	from connecting to two virtual AP interfaces at the same time.
2781  *
2782  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER: Hardware (or driver) manages the
2783  *	reordering buffer internally, guaranteeing mac80211 receives frames in
2784  *	order and does not need to manage its own reorder buffer or BA session
2785  *	timeout.
2786  *
2787  * @IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS: The device uses RSS and thus requires parallel RX,
2788  *	which implies using per-CPU station statistics.
2789  *
2790  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU: Hardware (or driver) supports software aggregated
2791  *	A-MSDU frames. Requires software tx queueing and fast-xmit support.
2792  *	When not using minstrel/minstrel_ht rate control, the driver must
2793  *	limit the maximum A-MSDU size based on the current tx rate by setting
2794  *	max_rc_amsdu_len in struct ieee80211_sta.
2795  *
2796  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST: Hardware (or driver) supports sending frag_list
2797  *	skbs, needed for zero-copy software A-MSDU.
2798  *
2799  * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK: The driver (or firmware) reports low ack event
2800  *	by ieee80211_report_low_ack() based on its own algorithm. For such
2801  *	drivers, mac80211 packet loss mechanism will not be triggered and driver
2802  *	is completely depending on firmware event for station kickout.
2803  *
2804  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG: Hardware does fragmentation by itself.
2805  *	The stack will not do fragmentation.
2806  *	The callback for @set_frag_threshold should be set as well.
2807  *
2808  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA: Hardware supports buffer STA on
2809  *	TDLS links.
2810  *
2811  * @IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP: The driver (or firmware) doesn't
2812  *	support QoS NDP for AP probing - that's most likely a driver bug.
2813  *
2814  * @IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ: use the TXQ for bufferable MMPDUs, this of
2815  *	course requires the driver to use TXQs to start with.
2816  *
2817  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW: (Hardware) rate control supports VHT
2818  *	extended NSS BW (dot11VHTExtendedNSSBWCapable). This flag will be set if
2819  *	the selected rate control algorithm sets %RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW
2820  *	but if the rate control is built-in then it must be set by the driver.
2821  *	See also the documentation for that flag.
2822  *
2823  * @IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ: use the extra non-TID per-station TXQ for all
2824  *	MMPDUs on station interfaces. This of course requires the driver to use
2825  *	TXQs to start with.
2826  *
2827  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN: Driver does not report accurate A-MPDU
2828  *	length in tx status information
2829  *
2830  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2831  *
2832  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2833  *	only for HE APs. Applies if @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID is set.
2834  *
2835  * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT: The card and driver is only
2836  *	aggregating MPDUs with the same keyid, allowing mac80211 to keep Tx
2837  *	A-MPDU sessions active while rekeying with Extended Key ID.
2838  *
2839  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports tx encapsulation
2840  *	offload
2841  *
2842  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports rx decapsulation
2843  *	offload
2844  *
2845  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP: Hardware supports concurrent rx
2846  *	decapsulation offload and passing raw 802.11 frames for monitor iface.
2847  *	If this is supported, the driver must pass both 802.3 frames for real
2848  *	usage and 802.11 frames with %RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR set for monitor to
2849  *	the stack.
2850  *
2851  * @IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION: HW/driver has support for BSS color
2852  *	collision detection and doesn't need it in software.
2853  *
2854  * @IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX: Hardware/driver handles transmitting
2855  *	multicast frames on all links, mac80211 should not do that.
2856  *
2857  * @IEEE80211_HW_DISALLOW_PUNCTURING: HW requires disabling puncturing in EHT
2858  *	and connecting with a lower bandwidth instead
2859  *
2860  * @IEEE80211_HW_HANDLES_QUIET_CSA: HW/driver handles quieting for CSA, so
2861  *	no need to stop queues. This really should be set by a driver that
2862  *	implements MLO, so operation can continue on other links when one
2863  *	link is switching.
2864  *
2865  * @IEEE80211_HW_STRICT: strictly enforce certain things mandated by the spec
2866  *	but otherwise ignored/worked around for interoperability. This is a
2867  *	HW flag so drivers can opt in according to their own control, e.g. in
2868  *	testing.
2869  *
2870  * @NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS: number of hardware flags, used for sizing arrays
2871  */
2872 enum ieee80211_hw_flags {
2873 	IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL,
2874 	IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS,
2875 	IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING,
2876 	IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC,
2877 	IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM,
2878 	IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC,
2879 	IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT,
2880 	IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION,
2881 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS,
2882 	IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK,
2883 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS,
2884 	IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE,
2885 	IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF,
2886 	IEEE80211_HW_NO_VIRTUAL_MONITOR,
2887 	IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF,
2888 	IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL,
2889 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT,
2890 	IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS,
2891 	IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR,
2892 	IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL,
2893 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK,
2894 	IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS,
2895 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW,
2896 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE,
2897 	IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF,
2898 	IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY,
2899 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES,
2900 	IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA,
2901 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS,
2902 	IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS,
2903 	IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW,
2904 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU,
2905 	IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS,
2906 	IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR,
2907 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER,
2908 	IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS,
2909 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU,
2910 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST,
2911 	IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK,
2912 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG,
2913 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA,
2914 	IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP,
2915 	IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ,
2916 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW,
2917 	IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ,
2918 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN,
2919 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID,
2920 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID,
2921 	IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT,
2922 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD,
2923 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD,
2924 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP,
2925 	IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION,
2926 	IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX,
2927 	IEEE80211_HW_DISALLOW_PUNCTURING,
2928 	IEEE80211_HW_HANDLES_QUIET_CSA,
2929 	IEEE80211_HW_STRICT,
2930 
2931 	/* keep last, obviously */
2932 	NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS
2933 };
2934 
2935 /**
2936  * struct ieee80211_hw - hardware information and state
2937  *
2938  * This structure contains the configuration and hardware
2939  * information for an 802.11 PHY.
2940  *
2941  * @wiphy: This points to the &struct wiphy allocated for this
2942  *	802.11 PHY. You must fill in the @perm_addr and @dev
2943  *	members of this structure using SET_IEEE80211_DEV()
2944  *	and SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(). Additionally, all supported
2945  *	bands (with channels, bitrates) are registered here.
2946  *
2947  * @conf: &struct ieee80211_conf, device configuration, don't use.
2948  *
2949  * @priv: pointer to private area that was allocated for driver use
2950  *	along with this structure.
2951  *
2952  * @flags: hardware flags, see &enum ieee80211_hw_flags.
2953  *
2954  * @extra_tx_headroom: headroom to reserve in each transmit skb
2955  *	for use by the driver (e.g. for transmit headers.)
2956  *
2957  * @extra_beacon_tailroom: tailroom to reserve in each beacon tx skb.
2958  *	Can be used by drivers to add extra IEs.
2959  *
2960  * @max_signal: Maximum value for signal (rssi) in RX information, used
2961  *	only when @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC or @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DB
2962  *
2963  * @max_listen_interval: max listen interval in units of beacon interval
2964  *	that HW supports
2965  *
2966  * @queues: number of available hardware transmit queues for
2967  *	data packets. WMM/QoS requires at least four, these
2968  *	queues need to have configurable access parameters.
2969  *
2970  * @rate_control_algorithm: rate control algorithm for this hardware.
2971  *	If unset (NULL), the default algorithm will be used. Must be
2972  *	set before calling ieee80211_register_hw().
2973  *
2974  * @vif_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2975  *	within &struct ieee80211_vif.
2976  * @sta_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2977  *	within &struct ieee80211_sta.
2978  * @chanctx_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2979  *	within &struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf.
2980  * @txq_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2981  *	within @struct ieee80211_txq.
2982  *
2983  * @max_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages the hw
2984  *	can handle.
2985  * @max_report_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages
2986  *	the hw can report back.
2987  * @max_rate_tries: maximum number of tries for each stage
2988  *
2989  * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximum buffer size (number of
2990  *	sub-frames) to be used for A-MPDU block ack receiver
2991  *	aggregation.
2992  *	This is only relevant if the device has restrictions on the
2993  *	number of subframes, if it relies on mac80211 to do reordering
2994  *	it shouldn't be set.
2995  *
2996  * @max_tx_aggregation_subframes: maximum number of subframes in an
2997  *	aggregate an HT/HE device will transmit. In HT AddBA we'll
2998  *	advertise a constant value of 64 as some older APs crash if
2999  *	the window size is smaller (an example is LinkSys WRT120N
3000  *	with FW v1.0.07 build 002 Jun 18 2012).
3001  *	For AddBA to HE capable peers this value will be used.
3002  *
3003  * @max_tx_fragments: maximum number of tx buffers per (A)-MSDU, sum
3004  *	of 1 + skb_shinfo(skb)->nr_frags for each skb in the frag_list.
3005  *
3006  * @offchannel_tx_hw_queue: HW queue ID to use for offchannel TX
3007  *	(if %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL is set)
3008  *
3009  * @radiotap_mcs_details: lists which MCS information can the HW
3010  *	reports, by default it is set to _MCS, _GI and _BW but doesn't
3011  *	include _FMT. Use %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_\* values, only
3012  *	adding _BW is supported today.
3013  *
3014  * @radiotap_vht_details: lists which VHT MCS information the HW reports,
3015  *	the default is _GI | _BANDWIDTH.
3016  *	Use the %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_VHT_KNOWN_\* values.
3017  *
3018  * @radiotap_timestamp: Information for the radiotap timestamp field; if the
3019  *	@units_pos member is set to a non-negative value then the timestamp
3020  *	field will be added and populated from the &struct ieee80211_rx_status
3021  *	device_timestamp.
3022  * @radiotap_timestamp.units_pos: Must be set to a combination of a
3023  *	IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_UNIT_* and a
3024  *	IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_SPOS_* value.
3025  * @radiotap_timestamp.accuracy: If non-negative, fills the accuracy in the
3026  *	radiotap field and the accuracy known flag will be set.
3027  *
3028  * @netdev_features: netdev features to be set in each netdev created
3029  *	from this HW. Note that not all features are usable with mac80211,
3030  *	other features will be rejected during HW registration.
3031  *
3032  * @uapsd_queues: This bitmap is included in (re)association frame to indicate
3033  *	for each access category if it is uAPSD trigger-enabled and delivery-
3034  *	enabled. Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_* to set this bitmap.
3035  *	Each bit corresponds to different AC. Value '1' in specific bit means
3036  *	that corresponding AC is both trigger- and delivery-enabled. '0' means
3037  *	neither enabled.
3038  *
3039  * @uapsd_max_sp_len: maximum number of total buffered frames the WMM AP may
3040  *	deliver to a WMM STA during any Service Period triggered by the WMM STA.
3041  *	Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_SP_* for correct values.
3042  *
3043  * @max_nan_de_entries: maximum number of NAN DE functions supported by the
3044  *	device.
3045  *
3046  * @tx_sk_pacing_shift: Pacing shift to set on TCP sockets when frames from
3047  *	them are encountered. The default should typically not be changed,
3048  *	unless the driver has good reasons for needing more buffers.
3049  *
3050  * @weight_multiplier: Driver specific airtime weight multiplier used while
3051  *	refilling deficit of each TXQ.
3052  *
3053  * @max_mtu: the max mtu could be set.
3054  *
3055  * @tx_power_levels: a list of power levels supported by the wifi hardware.
3056  * 	The power levels can be specified either as integer or fractions.
3057  * 	The power level at idx 0 shall be the maximum positive power level.
3058  *
3059  * @max_txpwr_levels_idx: the maximum valid idx of 'tx_power_levels' list.
3060  */
3061 struct ieee80211_hw {
3062 	struct ieee80211_conf conf;
3063 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
3064 	const char *rate_control_algorithm;
3065 	void *priv;
3066 	unsigned long flags[BITS_TO_LONGS(NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS)];
3067 	unsigned int extra_tx_headroom;
3068 	unsigned int extra_beacon_tailroom;
3069 	int vif_data_size;
3070 	int sta_data_size;
3071 	int chanctx_data_size;
3072 	int txq_data_size;
3073 	u16 queues;
3074 	u16 max_listen_interval;
3075 	s8 max_signal;
3076 	u8 max_rates;
3077 	u8 max_report_rates;
3078 	u8 max_rate_tries;
3079 	u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
3080 	u16 max_tx_aggregation_subframes;
3081 	u8 max_tx_fragments;
3082 	u8 offchannel_tx_hw_queue;
3083 	u8 radiotap_mcs_details;
3084 	u16 radiotap_vht_details;
3085 	struct {
3086 		int units_pos;
3087 		s16 accuracy;
3088 	} radiotap_timestamp;
3089 	netdev_features_t netdev_features;
3090 	u8 uapsd_queues;
3091 	u8 uapsd_max_sp_len;
3092 	u8 max_nan_de_entries;
3093 	u8 tx_sk_pacing_shift;
3094 	u8 weight_multiplier;
3095 	u32 max_mtu;
3096 	const s8 *tx_power_levels;
3097 	u8 max_txpwr_levels_idx;
3098 };
3099 
_ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)3100 static inline bool _ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3101 				       enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
3102 {
3103 	return test_bit(flg, hw->flags);
3104 }
3105 #define ieee80211_hw_check(hw, flg)	_ieee80211_hw_check(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
3106 
_ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)3107 static inline void _ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3108 				     enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
3109 {
3110 	return __set_bit(flg, hw->flags);
3111 }
3112 #define ieee80211_hw_set(hw, flg)	_ieee80211_hw_set(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
3113 
3114 /**
3115  * struct ieee80211_scan_request - hw scan request
3116  *
3117  * @ies: pointers different parts of IEs (in req.ie)
3118  * @req: cfg80211 request.
3119  */
3120 struct ieee80211_scan_request {
3121 	struct ieee80211_scan_ies ies;
3122 
3123 	/* Keep last */
3124 	struct cfg80211_scan_request req;
3125 };
3126 
3127 /**
3128  * struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params - TDLS channel switch parameters
3129  *
3130  * @sta: peer this TDLS channel-switch request/response came from
3131  * @chandef: channel referenced in a TDLS channel-switch request
3132  * @action_code: see &enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode
3133  * @status: channel-switch response status
3134  * @timestamp: time at which the frame was received
3135  * @switch_time: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
3136  * @switch_timeout: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
3137  * @tmpl_skb: TDLS switch-channel response template
3138  * @ch_sw_tm_ie: offset of the channel-switch timing IE inside @tmpl_skb
3139  */
3140 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params {
3141 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
3142 	struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef;
3143 	u8 action_code;
3144 	u32 status;
3145 	u32 timestamp;
3146 	u16 switch_time;
3147 	u16 switch_timeout;
3148 	struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb;
3149 	u32 ch_sw_tm_ie;
3150 };
3151 
3152 /**
3153  * wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw - return a mac80211 driver hw struct from a wiphy
3154  *
3155  * @wiphy: the &struct wiphy which we want to query
3156  *
3157  * mac80211 drivers can use this to get to their respective
3158  * &struct ieee80211_hw. Drivers wishing to get to their own private
3159  * structure can then access it via hw->priv. Note that mac802111 drivers should
3160  * not use wiphy_priv() to try to get their private driver structure as this
3161  * is already used internally by mac80211.
3162  *
3163  * Return: The mac80211 driver hw struct of @wiphy.
3164  */
3165 struct ieee80211_hw *wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw(struct wiphy *wiphy);
3166 
3167 /**
3168  * SET_IEEE80211_DEV - set device for 802.11 hardware
3169  *
3170  * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the device for
3171  * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
3172  */
SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct device * dev)3173 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct device *dev)
3174 {
3175 	set_wiphy_dev(hw->wiphy, dev);
3176 }
3177 
3178 /**
3179  * SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR - set the permanent MAC address for 802.11 hardware
3180  *
3181  * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the MAC address for
3182  * @addr: the address to set
3183  */
SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const u8 * addr)3184 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, const u8 *addr)
3185 {
3186 	memcpy(hw->wiphy->perm_addr, addr, ETH_ALEN);
3187 }
3188 
3189 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const struct ieee80211_tx_info * c)3190 ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3191 		      const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
3192 {
3193 	if (WARN_ON_ONCE(c->control.rates[0].idx < 0))
3194 		return NULL;
3195 	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[0].idx];
3196 }
3197 
3198 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const struct ieee80211_tx_info * c)3199 ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3200 			   const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
3201 {
3202 	if (c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx < 0)
3203 		return NULL;
3204 	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx];
3205 }
3206 
3207 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const struct ieee80211_tx_info * c,int idx)3208 ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3209 			     const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c, int idx)
3210 {
3211 	if (c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx < 0)
3212 		return NULL;
3213 	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx];
3214 }
3215 
3216 /**
3217  * ieee80211_free_txskb - free TX skb
3218  * @hw: the hardware
3219  * @skb: the skb
3220  *
3221  * Free a transmit skb. Use this function when some failure
3222  * to transmit happened and thus status cannot be reported.
3223  */
3224 void ieee80211_free_txskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
3225 
3226 /**
3227  * ieee80211_purge_tx_queue - purge TX skb queue
3228  * @hw: the hardware
3229  * @skbs: the skbs
3230  *
3231  * Free a set of transmit skbs. Use this function when device is going to stop
3232  * but some transmit skbs without TX status are still queued.
3233  * This function does not take the list lock and the caller must hold the
3234  * relevant locks to use it.
3235  */
3236 void ieee80211_purge_tx_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3237 			      struct sk_buff_head *skbs);
3238 
3239 /**
3240  * DOC: Hardware crypto acceleration
3241  *
3242  * mac80211 is capable of taking advantage of many hardware
3243  * acceleration designs for encryption and decryption operations.
3244  *
3245  * The set_key() callback in the &struct ieee80211_ops for a given
3246  * device is called to enable hardware acceleration of encryption and
3247  * decryption. The callback takes a @sta parameter that will be NULL
3248  * for default keys or keys used for transmission only, or point to
3249  * the station information for the peer for individual keys.
3250  * Multiple transmission keys with the same key index may be used when
3251  * VLANs are configured for an access point.
3252  *
3253  * When transmitting, the TX control data will use the @hw_key_idx
3254  * selected by the driver by modifying the &struct ieee80211_key_conf
3255  * pointed to by the @key parameter to the set_key() function.
3256  *
3257  * The set_key() call for the %SET_KEY command should return 0 if
3258  * the key is now in use, -%EOPNOTSUPP or -%ENOSPC if it couldn't be
3259  * added; if you return 0 then hw_key_idx must be assigned to the
3260  * hardware key index. You are free to use the full u8 range.
3261  *
3262  * Note that in the case that the @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL flag is
3263  * set, mac80211 will not automatically fall back to software crypto if
3264  * enabling hardware crypto failed. The set_key() call may also return the
3265  * value 1 to permit this specific key/algorithm to be done in software.
3266  *
3267  * When the cmd is %DISABLE_KEY then it must succeed.
3268  *
3269  * Note that it is permissible to not decrypt a frame even if a key
3270  * for it has been uploaded to hardware. The stack will not make any
3271  * decision based on whether a key has been uploaded or not but rather
3272  * based on the receive flags.
3273  *
3274  * The &struct ieee80211_key_conf structure pointed to by the @key
3275  * parameter is guaranteed to be valid until another call to set_key()
3276  * removes it, but it can only be used as a cookie to differentiate
3277  * keys.
3278  *
3279  * In TKIP some HW need to be provided a phase 1 key, for RX decryption
3280  * acceleration (i.e. iwlwifi). Those drivers should provide update_tkip_key
3281  * handler.
3282  * The update_tkip_key() call updates the driver with the new phase 1 key.
3283  * This happens every time the iv16 wraps around (every 65536 packets). The
3284  * set_key() call will happen only once for each key (unless the AP did
3285  * rekeying); it will not include a valid phase 1 key. The valid phase 1 key is
3286  * provided by update_tkip_key only. The trigger that makes mac80211 call this
3287  * handler is software decryption with wrap around of iv16.
3288  *
3289  * The set_default_unicast_key() call updates the default WEP key index
3290  * configured to the hardware for WEP encryption type. This is required
3291  * for devices that support offload of data packets (e.g. ARP responses).
3292  *
3293  * Mac80211 drivers should set the @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0 flag
3294  * when they are able to replace in-use PTK keys according to the following
3295  * requirements:
3296  * 1) They do not hand over frames decrypted with the old key to mac80211
3297       once the call to set_key() with command %DISABLE_KEY has been completed,
3298    2) either drop or continue to use the old key for any outgoing frames queued
3299       at the time of the key deletion (including re-transmits),
3300    3) never send out a frame queued prior to the set_key() %SET_KEY command
3301       encrypted with the new key when also needing
3302       @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV and
3303    4) never send out a frame unencrypted when it should be encrypted.
3304    Mac80211 will not queue any new frames for a deleted key to the driver.
3305  */
3306 
3307 /**
3308  * DOC: Powersave support
3309  *
3310  * mac80211 has support for various powersave implementations.
3311  *
3312  * First, it can support hardware that handles all powersaving by itself;
3313  * such hardware should simply set the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS hardware
3314  * flag. In that case, it will be told about the desired powersave mode
3315  * with the %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag depending on the association status.
3316  * The hardware must take care of sending nullfunc frames when necessary,
3317  * i.e. when entering and leaving powersave mode. The hardware is required
3318  * to look at the AID in beacons and signal to the AP that it woke up when
3319  * it finds traffic directed to it.
3320  *
3321  * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag enabled means that the powersave mode defined in
3322  * IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2 is enabled. This is not to be confused
3323  * with hardware wakeup and sleep states. Driver is responsible for waking
3324  * up the hardware before issuing commands to the hardware and putting it
3325  * back to sleep at appropriate times.
3326  *
3327  * When PS is enabled, hardware needs to wakeup for beacons and receive the
3328  * buffered multicast/broadcast frames after the beacon. Also it must be
3329  * possible to send frames and receive the acknowledment frame.
3330  *
3331  * Other hardware designs cannot send nullfunc frames by themselves and also
3332  * need software support for parsing the TIM bitmap. This is also supported
3333  * by mac80211 by combining the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS and
3334  * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK flags. The hardware is of course still
3335  * required to pass up beacons. The hardware is still required to handle
3336  * waking up for multicast traffic; if it cannot the driver must handle that
3337  * as best as it can; mac80211 is too slow to do that.
3338  *
3339  * Dynamic powersave is an extension to normal powersave in which the
3340  * hardware stays awake for a user-specified period of time after sending a
3341  * frame so that reply frames need not be buffered and therefore delayed to
3342  * the next wakeup. It's a compromise of getting good enough latency when
3343  * there's data traffic and still saving significantly power in idle
3344  * periods.
3345  *
3346  * Dynamic powersave is simply supported by mac80211 enabling and disabling
3347  * PS based on traffic. Driver needs to only set %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS
3348  * flag and mac80211 will handle everything automatically. Additionally,
3349  * hardware having support for the dynamic PS feature may set the
3350  * %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS flag to indicate that it can support
3351  * dynamic PS mode itself. The driver needs to look at the
3352  * @dynamic_ps_timeout hardware configuration value and use it that value
3353  * whenever %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. In this case mac80211 will disable
3354  * dynamic PS feature in stack and will just keep %IEEE80211_CONF_PS
3355  * enabled whenever user has enabled powersave.
3356  *
3357  * Driver informs U-APSD client support by enabling
3358  * %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD flag. The mode is configured through the
3359  * uapsd parameter in conf_tx() operation. Hardware needs to send the QoS
3360  * Nullfunc frames and stay awake until the service period has ended. To
3361  * utilize U-APSD, dynamic powersave is disabled for voip AC and all frames
3362  * from that AC are transmitted with powersave enabled.
3363  *
3364  * Note: U-APSD client mode is not yet supported with
3365  * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK.
3366  */
3367 
3368 /**
3369  * DOC: Beacon filter support
3370  *
3371  * Some hardware have beacon filter support to reduce host cpu wakeups
3372  * which will reduce system power consumption. It usually works so that
3373  * the firmware creates a checksum of the beacon but omits all constantly
3374  * changing elements (TSF, TIM etc). Whenever the checksum changes the
3375  * beacon is forwarded to the host, otherwise it will be just dropped. That
3376  * way the host will only receive beacons where some relevant information
3377  * (for example ERP protection or WMM settings) have changed.
3378  *
3379  * Beacon filter support is advertised with the %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER
3380  * interface capability. The driver needs to enable beacon filter support
3381  * whenever power save is enabled, that is %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. When
3382  * power save is enabled, the stack will not check for beacon loss and the
3383  * driver needs to notify about loss of beacons with ieee80211_beacon_loss().
3384  *
3385  * The time (or number of beacons missed) until the firmware notifies the
3386  * driver of a beacon loss event (which in turn causes the driver to call
3387  * ieee80211_beacon_loss()) should be configurable and will be controlled
3388  * by mac80211 and the roaming algorithm in the future.
3389  *
3390  * Since there may be constantly changing information elements that nothing
3391  * in the software stack cares about, we will, in the future, have mac80211
3392  * tell the driver which information elements are interesting in the sense
3393  * that we want to see changes in them. This will include
3394  *
3395  *  - a list of information element IDs
3396  *  - a list of OUIs for the vendor information element
3397  *
3398  * Ideally, the hardware would filter out any beacons without changes in the
3399  * requested elements, but if it cannot support that it may, at the expense
3400  * of some efficiency, filter out only a subset. For example, if the device
3401  * doesn't support checking for OUIs it should pass up all changes in all
3402  * vendor information elements.
3403  *
3404  * Note that change, for the sake of simplification, also includes information
3405  * elements appearing or disappearing from the beacon.
3406  *
3407  * Some hardware supports an "ignore list" instead. Just make sure nothing
3408  * that was requested is on the ignore list, and include commonly changing
3409  * information element IDs in the ignore list, for example 11 (BSS load) and
3410  * the various vendor-assigned IEs with unknown contents (128, 129, 133-136,
3411  * 149, 150, 155, 156, 173, 176, 178, 179, 219); for forward compatibility
3412  * it could also include some currently unused IDs.
3413  *
3414  *
3415  * In addition to these capabilities, hardware should support notifying the
3416  * host of changes in the beacon RSSI. This is relevant to implement roaming
3417  * when no traffic is flowing (when traffic is flowing we see the RSSI of
3418  * the received data packets). This can consist of notifying the host when
3419  * the RSSI changes significantly or when it drops below or rises above
3420  * configurable thresholds. In the future these thresholds will also be
3421  * configured by mac80211 (which gets them from userspace) to implement
3422  * them as the roaming algorithm requires.
3423  *
3424  * If the hardware cannot implement this, the driver should ask it to
3425  * periodically pass beacon frames to the host so that software can do the
3426  * signal strength threshold checking.
3427  */
3428 
3429 /**
3430  * DOC: Spatial multiplexing power save
3431  *
3432  * SMPS (Spatial multiplexing power save) is a mechanism to conserve
3433  * power in an 802.11n implementation. For details on the mechanism
3434  * and rationale, please refer to 802.11 (as amended by 802.11n-2009)
3435  * "11.2.3 SM power save".
3436  *
3437  * The mac80211 implementation is capable of sending action frames
3438  * to update the AP about the station's SMPS mode, and will instruct
3439  * the driver to enter the specific mode. It will also announce the
3440  * requested SMPS mode during the association handshake. Hardware
3441  * support for this feature is required, and can be indicated by
3442  * hardware flags.
3443  *
3444  * The default mode will be "automatic", which nl80211/cfg80211
3445  * defines to be dynamic SMPS in (regular) powersave, and SMPS
3446  * turned off otherwise.
3447  *
3448  * To support this feature, the driver must set the appropriate
3449  * hardware support flags, and handle the SMPS flag to the config()
3450  * operation. It will then with this mechanism be instructed to
3451  * enter the requested SMPS mode while associated to an HT AP.
3452  */
3453 
3454 /**
3455  * DOC: Frame filtering
3456  *
3457  * mac80211 requires to see many management frames for proper
3458  * operation, and users may want to see many more frames when
3459  * in monitor mode. However, for best CPU usage and power consumption,
3460  * having as few frames as possible percolate through the stack is
3461  * desirable. Hence, the hardware should filter as much as possible.
3462  *
3463  * To achieve this, mac80211 uses filter flags (see below) to tell
3464  * the driver's configure_filter() function which frames should be
3465  * passed to mac80211 and which should be filtered out.
3466  *
3467  * Before configure_filter() is invoked, the prepare_multicast()
3468  * callback is invoked with the parameters @mc_count and @mc_list
3469  * for the combined multicast address list of all virtual interfaces.
3470  * It's use is optional, and it returns a u64 that is passed to
3471  * configure_filter(). Additionally, configure_filter() has the
3472  * arguments @changed_flags telling which flags were changed and
3473  * @total_flags with the new flag states.
3474  *
3475  * If your device has no multicast address filters your driver will
3476  * need to check both the %FIF_ALLMULTI flag and the @mc_count
3477  * parameter to see whether multicast frames should be accepted
3478  * or dropped.
3479  *
3480  * All unsupported flags in @total_flags must be cleared.
3481  * Hardware does not support a flag if it is incapable of _passing_
3482  * the frame to the stack. Otherwise the driver must ignore
3483  * the flag, but not clear it.
3484  * You must _only_ clear the flag (announce no support for the
3485  * flag to mac80211) if you are not able to pass the packet type
3486  * to the stack (so the hardware always filters it).
3487  * So for example, you should clear @FIF_CONTROL, if your hardware
3488  * always filters control frames. If your hardware always passes
3489  * control frames to the kernel and is incapable of filtering them,
3490  * you do _not_ clear the @FIF_CONTROL flag.
3491  * This rule applies to all other FIF flags as well.
3492  */
3493 
3494 /**
3495  * DOC: AP support for powersaving clients
3496  *
3497  * In order to implement AP and P2P GO modes, mac80211 has support for
3498  * client powersaving, both "legacy" PS (PS-Poll/null data) and uAPSD.
3499  * There currently is no support for sAPSD.
3500  *
3501  * There is one assumption that mac80211 makes, namely that a client
3502  * will not poll with PS-Poll and trigger with uAPSD at the same time.
3503  * Both are supported, and both can be used by the same client, but
3504  * they can't be used concurrently by the same client. This simplifies
3505  * the driver code.
3506  *
3507  * The first thing to keep in mind is that there is a flag for complete
3508  * driver implementation: %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS. If this flag is set,
3509  * mac80211 expects the driver to handle most of the state machine for
3510  * powersaving clients and will ignore the PM bit in incoming frames.
3511  * Drivers then use ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() to inform mac80211 of
3512  * stations' powersave transitions. In this mode, mac80211 also doesn't
3513  * handle PS-Poll/uAPSD.
3514  *
3515  * In the mode without %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS, mac80211 will check the
3516  * PM bit in incoming frames for client powersave transitions. When a
3517  * station goes to sleep, we will stop transmitting to it. There is,
3518  * however, a race condition: a station might go to sleep while there is
3519  * data buffered on hardware queues. If the device has support for this
3520  * it will reject frames, and the driver should give the frames back to
3521  * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED flag set which will
3522  * cause mac80211 to retry the frame when the station wakes up. The
3523  * driver is also notified of powersave transitions by calling its
3524  * @sta_notify callback.
3525  *
3526  * When the station is asleep, it has three choices: it can wake up,
3527  * it can PS-Poll, or it can possibly start a uAPSD service period.
3528  * Waking up is implemented by simply transmitting all buffered (and
3529  * filtered) frames to the station. This is the easiest case. When
3530  * the station sends a PS-Poll or a uAPSD trigger frame, mac80211
3531  * will inform the driver of this with the @allow_buffered_frames
3532  * callback; this callback is optional. mac80211 will then transmit
3533  * the frames as usual and set the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER
3534  * on each frame. The last frame in the service period (or the only
3535  * response to a PS-Poll) also has %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set to
3536  * indicate that it ends the service period; as this frame must have
3537  * TX status report it also sets %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS.
3538  * When TX status is reported for this frame, the service period is
3539  * marked has having ended and a new one can be started by the peer.
3540  *
3541  * Additionally, non-bufferable MMPDUs can also be transmitted by
3542  * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER set in them.
3543  *
3544  * Another race condition can happen on some devices like iwlwifi
3545  * when there are frames queued for the station and it wakes up
3546  * or polls; the frames that are already queued could end up being
3547  * transmitted first instead, causing reordering and/or wrong
3548  * processing of the EOSP. The cause is that allowing frames to be
3549  * transmitted to a certain station is out-of-band communication to
3550  * the device. To allow this problem to be solved, the driver can
3551  * call ieee80211_sta_block_awake() if frames are buffered when it
3552  * is notified that the station went to sleep. When all these frames
3553  * have been filtered (see above), it must call the function again
3554  * to indicate that the station is no longer blocked.
3555  *
3556  * If the driver buffers frames in the driver for aggregation in any
3557  * way, it must use the ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() call when it is
3558  * notified of the station going to sleep to inform mac80211 of any
3559  * TIDs that have frames buffered. Note that when a station wakes up
3560  * this information is reset (hence the requirement to call it when
3561  * informed of the station going to sleep). Then, when a service
3562  * period starts for any reason, @release_buffered_frames is called
3563  * with the number of frames to be released and which TIDs they are
3564  * to come from. In this case, the driver is responsible for setting
3565  * the EOSP (for uAPSD) and MORE_DATA bits in the released frames.
3566  * To help the @more_data parameter is passed to tell the driver if
3567  * there is more data on other TIDs -- the TIDs to release frames
3568  * from are ignored since mac80211 doesn't know how many frames the
3569  * buffers for those TIDs contain.
3570  *
3571  * If the driver also implement GO mode, where absence periods may
3572  * shorten service periods (or abort PS-Poll responses), it must
3573  * filter those response frames except in the case of frames that
3574  * are buffered in the driver -- those must remain buffered to avoid
3575  * reordering. Because it is possible that no frames are released
3576  * in this case, the driver must call ieee80211_sta_eosp()
3577  * to indicate to mac80211 that the service period ended anyway.
3578  *
3579  * Finally, if frames from multiple TIDs are released from mac80211
3580  * but the driver might reorder them, it must clear & set the flags
3581  * appropriately (only the last frame may have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
3582  * and also take care of the EOSP and MORE_DATA bits in the frame.
3583  * The driver may also use ieee80211_sta_eosp() in this case.
3584  *
3585  * Note that if the driver ever buffers frames other than QoS-data
3586  * frames, it must take care to never send a non-QoS-data frame as
3587  * the last frame in a service period, adding a QoS-nulldata frame
3588  * after a non-QoS-data frame if needed.
3589  */
3590 
3591 /**
3592  * DOC: HW queue control
3593  *
3594  * Before HW queue control was introduced, mac80211 only had a single static
3595  * assignment of per-interface AC software queues to hardware queues. This
3596  * was problematic for a few reasons:
3597  * 1) off-channel transmissions might get stuck behind other frames
3598  * 2) multiple virtual interfaces couldn't be handled correctly
3599  * 3) after-DTIM frames could get stuck behind other frames
3600  *
3601  * To solve this, hardware typically uses multiple different queues for all
3602  * the different usages, and this needs to be propagated into mac80211 so it
3603  * won't have the same problem with the software queues.
3604  *
3605  * Therefore, mac80211 now offers the %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL capability
3606  * flag that tells it that the driver implements its own queue control. To do
3607  * so, the driver will set up the various queues in each &struct ieee80211_vif
3608  * and the offchannel queue in &struct ieee80211_hw. In response, mac80211 will
3609  * use those queue IDs in the hw_queue field of &struct ieee80211_tx_info and
3610  * if necessary will queue the frame on the right software queue that mirrors
3611  * the hardware queue.
3612  * Additionally, the driver has to then use these HW queue IDs for the queue
3613  * management functions (ieee80211_stop_queue() et al.)
3614  *
3615  * The driver is free to set up the queue mappings as needed; multiple virtual
3616  * interfaces may map to the same hardware queues if needed. The setup has to
3617  * happen during add_interface or change_interface callbacks. For example, a
3618  * driver supporting station+station and station+AP modes might decide to have
3619  * 10 hardware queues to handle different scenarios:
3620  *
3621  * 4 AC HW queues for 1st vif: 0, 1, 2, 3
3622  * 4 AC HW queues for 2nd vif: 4, 5, 6, 7
3623  * after-DTIM queue for AP:   8
3624  * off-channel queue:         9
3625  *
3626  * It would then set up the hardware like this:
3627  *   hw.offchannel_tx_hw_queue = 9
3628  *
3629  * and the first virtual interface that is added as follows:
3630  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VO] = 0
3631  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VI] = 1
3632  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BE] = 2
3633  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BK] = 3
3634  *   vif.cab_queue = 8 // if AP mode, otherwise %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3635  * and the second virtual interface with 4-7.
3636  *
3637  * If queue 6 gets full, for example, mac80211 would only stop the second
3638  * virtual interface's BE queue since virtual interface queues are per AC.
3639  *
3640  * Note that the vif.cab_queue value should be set to %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3641  * whenever the queue is not used (i.e. the interface is not in AP mode) if the
3642  * queue could potentially be shared since mac80211 will look at cab_queue when
3643  * a queue is stopped/woken even if the interface is not in AP mode.
3644  */
3645 
3646 /**
3647  * enum ieee80211_filter_flags - hardware filter flags
3648  *
3649  * These flags determine what the filter in hardware should be
3650  * programmed to let through and what should not be passed to the
3651  * stack. It is always safe to pass more frames than requested,
3652  * but this has negative impact on power consumption.
3653  *
3654  * @FIF_ALLMULTI: pass all multicast frames, this is used if requested
3655  *	by the user or if the hardware is not capable of filtering by
3656  *	multicast address.
3657  *
3658  * @FIF_FCSFAIL: pass frames with failed FCS (but you need to set the
3659  *	%RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC for them)
3660  *
3661  * @FIF_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with failed PLCP CRC (but you need to set
3662  *	the %RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC for them
3663  *
3664  * @FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC: This flag is set during scanning to indicate
3665  *	to the hardware that it should not filter beacons or probe responses
3666  *	by BSSID. Filtering them can greatly reduce the amount of processing
3667  *	mac80211 needs to do and the amount of CPU wakeups, so you should
3668  *	honour this flag if possible.
3669  *
3670  * @FIF_CONTROL: pass control frames (except for PS Poll) addressed to this
3671  *	station
3672  *
3673  * @FIF_OTHER_BSS: pass frames destined to other BSSes
3674  *
3675  * @FIF_PSPOLL: pass PS Poll frames
3676  *
3677  * @FIF_PROBE_REQ: pass probe request frames
3678  *
3679  * @FIF_MCAST_ACTION: pass multicast Action frames
3680  */
3681 enum ieee80211_filter_flags {
3682 	FIF_ALLMULTI		= 1<<1,
3683 	FIF_FCSFAIL		= 1<<2,
3684 	FIF_PLCPFAIL		= 1<<3,
3685 	FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC	= 1<<4,
3686 	FIF_CONTROL		= 1<<5,
3687 	FIF_OTHER_BSS		= 1<<6,
3688 	FIF_PSPOLL		= 1<<7,
3689 	FIF_PROBE_REQ		= 1<<8,
3690 	FIF_MCAST_ACTION	= 1<<9,
3691 };
3692 
3693 /**
3694  * enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action - A-MPDU actions
3695  *
3696  * These flags are used with the ampdu_action() callback in
3697  * &struct ieee80211_ops to indicate which action is needed.
3698  *
3699  * Note that drivers MUST be able to deal with a TX aggregation
3700  * session being stopped even before they OK'ed starting it by
3701  * calling ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe, because the peer
3702  * might receive the addBA frame and send a delBA right away!
3703  *
3704  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START: start RX aggregation
3705  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP: stop RX aggregation
3706  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START: start TX aggregation, the driver must either
3707  *	call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() or
3708  *	call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() with status
3709  *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA to delay addba after
3710  *	ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe is called, or just return the special
3711  *	status %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE.
3712  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL: TX aggregation has become operational
3713  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT: stop TX aggregation but continue transmitting
3714  *	queued packets, now unaggregated. After all packets are transmitted the
3715  *	driver has to call ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe().
3716  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH: stop TX aggregation and flush all packets,
3717  *	called when the station is removed. There's no need or reason to call
3718  *	ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() in this case as mac80211 assumes the
3719  *	session is gone and removes the station.
3720  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT: called when TX aggregation is stopped
3721  *	but the driver hasn't called ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() yet and
3722  *	now the connection is dropped and the station will be removed. Drivers
3723  *	should clean up and drop remaining packets when this is called.
3724  */
3725 enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action {
3726 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START,
3727 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP,
3728 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START,
3729 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT,
3730 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH,
3731 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT,
3732 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL,
3733 };
3734 
3735 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE 1
3736 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA 2
3737 
3738 /**
3739  * struct ieee80211_ampdu_params - AMPDU action parameters
3740  *
3741  * @action: the ampdu action, value from %ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
3742  * @sta: peer of this AMPDU session
3743  * @tid: tid of the BA session
3744  * @ssn: start sequence number of the session. TX/RX_STOP can pass 0. When
3745  *	action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START the driver passes back the
3746  *	actual ssn value used to start the session and writes the value here.
3747  * @buf_size: reorder buffer size  (number of subframes). Valid only when the
3748  *	action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START or
3749  *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3750  * @amsdu: indicates the peer's ability to receive A-MSDU within A-MPDU.
3751  *	valid when the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3752  * @timeout: BA session timeout. Valid only when the action is set to
3753  *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START
3754  */
3755 struct ieee80211_ampdu_params {
3756 	enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action action;
3757 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
3758 	u16 tid;
3759 	u16 ssn;
3760 	u16 buf_size;
3761 	bool amsdu;
3762 	u16 timeout;
3763 };
3764 
3765 /**
3766  * enum ieee80211_frame_release_type - frame release reason
3767  * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL: frame released for PS-Poll
3768  * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD: frame(s) released due to
3769  *	frame received on trigger-enabled AC
3770  */
3771 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type {
3772 	IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL,
3773 	IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD,
3774 };
3775 
3776 /**
3777  * enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed - flags to indicate what changed
3778  *
3779  * @IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED: The bandwidth that can be used to transmit
3780  *	to this station changed. The actual bandwidth is in the station
3781  *	information -- for HT20/40 the IEEE80211_HT_CAP_SUP_WIDTH_20_40
3782  *	flag changes, for HT and VHT the bandwidth field changes.
3783  * @IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED: The SMPS state of the station changed.
3784  * @IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED: The supported rate set of this peer
3785  *	changed (in IBSS mode) due to discovering more information about
3786  *	the peer.
3787  * @IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED: N_SS (number of spatial streams) was changed
3788  *	by the peer
3789  */
3790 enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed {
3791 	IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED		= BIT(0),
3792 	IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED	= BIT(1),
3793 	IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED	= BIT(2),
3794 	IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED	= BIT(3),
3795 };
3796 
3797 /**
3798  * enum ieee80211_roc_type - remain on channel type
3799  *
3800  * With the support for multi channel contexts and multi channel operations,
3801  * remain on channel operations might be limited/deferred/aborted by other
3802  * flows/operations which have higher priority (and vice versa).
3803  * Specifying the ROC type can be used by devices to prioritize the ROC
3804  * operations compared to other operations/flows.
3805  *
3806  * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL: There are no special requirements for this ROC.
3807  * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX: The remain on channel request is required
3808  *	for sending management frames offchannel.
3809  */
3810 enum ieee80211_roc_type {
3811 	IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL = 0,
3812 	IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX,
3813 };
3814 
3815 /**
3816  * enum ieee80211_reconfig_type - reconfig type
3817  *
3818  * This enum is used by the reconfig_complete() callback to indicate what
3819  * reconfiguration type was completed.
3820  *
3821  * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART: hw restart type
3822  *	(also due to resume() callback returning 1)
3823  * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND: suspend type (regardless
3824  *	of wowlan configuration)
3825  */
3826 enum ieee80211_reconfig_type {
3827 	IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART,
3828 	IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND,
3829 };
3830 
3831 /**
3832  * struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info - prepare TX information
3833  * @duration: if non-zero, hint about the required duration,
3834  *	only used with the mgd_prepare_tx() method.
3835  * @subtype: frame subtype (auth, (re)assoc, deauth, disassoc)
3836  * @success: whether the frame exchange was successful, only
3837  *	used with the mgd_complete_tx() method, and then only
3838  *	valid for auth and (re)assoc.
3839  * @was_assoc: set if this call is due to deauth/disassoc
3840  *	while just having been associated
3841  * @link_id: the link id on which the frame will be TX'ed.
3842  *	0 for a non-MLO connection.
3843  */
3844 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info {
3845 	u16 duration;
3846 	u16 subtype;
3847 	u8 success:1, was_assoc:1;
3848 	int link_id;
3849 };
3850 
3851 /**
3852  * struct ieee80211_ops - callbacks from mac80211 to the driver
3853  *
3854  * This structure contains various callbacks that the driver may
3855  * handle or, in some cases, must handle, for example to configure
3856  * the hardware to a new channel or to transmit a frame.
3857  *
3858  * @tx: Handler that 802.11 module calls for each transmitted frame.
3859  *	skb contains the buffer starting from the IEEE 802.11 header.
3860  *	The low-level driver should send the frame out based on
3861  *	configuration in the TX control data. This handler should,
3862  *	preferably, never fail and stop queues appropriately.
3863  *	Must be atomic.
3864  *
3865  * @start: Called before the first netdevice attached to the hardware
3866  *	is enabled. This should turn on the hardware and must turn on
3867  *	frame reception (for possibly enabled monitor interfaces.)
3868  *	Returns negative error codes, these may be seen in userspace,
3869  *	or zero.
3870  *	When the device is started it should not have a MAC address
3871  *	to avoid acknowledging frames before a non-monitor device
3872  *	is added.
3873  *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3874  *
3875  * @stop: Called after last netdevice attached to the hardware
3876  *	is disabled. This should turn off the hardware (at least
3877  *	it must turn off frame reception.)
3878  *	May be called right after add_interface if that rejects
3879  *	an interface. If you added any work onto the mac80211 workqueue
3880  *	you should ensure to cancel it on this callback.
3881  *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3882  *
3883  * @suspend: Suspend the device; mac80211 itself will quiesce before and
3884  *	stop transmitting and doing any other configuration, and then
3885  *	ask the device to suspend. This is only invoked when WoWLAN is
3886  *	configured, otherwise the device is deconfigured completely and
3887  *	reconfigured at resume time.
3888  *	The driver may also impose special conditions under which it
3889  *	wants to use the "normal" suspend (deconfigure), say if it only
3890  *	supports WoWLAN when the device is associated. In this case, it
3891  *	must return 1 from this function.
3892  *
3893  * @resume: If WoWLAN was configured, this indicates that mac80211 is
3894  *	now resuming its operation, after this the device must be fully
3895  *	functional again. If this returns an error, the only way out is
3896  *	to also unregister the device. If it returns 1, then mac80211
3897  *	will also go through the regular complete restart on resume.
3898  *
3899  * @set_wakeup: Enable or disable wakeup when WoWLAN configuration is
3900  *	modified. The reason is that device_set_wakeup_enable() is
3901  *	supposed to be called when the configuration changes, not only
3902  *	in suspend().
3903  *
3904  * @add_interface: Called when a netdevice attached to the hardware is
3905  *	enabled. Because it is not called for monitor mode devices, @start
3906  *	and @stop must be implemented.
3907  *	The driver should perform any initialization it needs before
3908  *	the device can be enabled. The initial configuration for the
3909  *	interface is given in the conf parameter.
3910  *	The callback may refuse to add an interface by returning a
3911  *	negative error code (which will be seen in userspace.)
3912  *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3913  *
3914  * @change_interface: Called when a netdevice changes type. This callback
3915  *	is optional, but only if it is supported can interface types be
3916  *	switched while the interface is UP. The callback may sleep.
3917  *	Note that while an interface is being switched, it will not be
3918  *	found by the interface iteration callbacks.
3919  *
3920  * @remove_interface: Notifies a driver that an interface is going down.
3921  *	The @stop callback is called after this if it is the last interface
3922  *	and no monitor interfaces are present.
3923  *	When all interfaces are removed, the MAC address in the hardware
3924  *	must be cleared so the device no longer acknowledges packets,
3925  *	the mac_addr member of the conf structure is, however, set to the
3926  *	MAC address of the device going away.
3927  *	Hence, this callback must be implemented. It can sleep.
3928  *
3929  * @config: Handler for configuration requests. IEEE 802.11 code calls this
3930  *	function to change hardware configuration, e.g., channel.
3931  *	This function should never fail but returns a negative error code
3932  *	if it does. The callback can sleep.
3933  *
3934  * @bss_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to BSS
3935  *	parameters that may vary during BSS's lifespan, and may affect low
3936  *	level driver (e.g. assoc/disassoc status, erp parameters).
3937  *	This function should not be used if no BSS has been set, unless
3938  *	for association indication. The @changed parameter indicates which
3939  *	of the bss parameters has changed when a call is made. The callback
3940  *	can sleep.
3941  *	Note: this callback is called if @vif_cfg_changed or @link_info_changed
3942  *	are not implemented.
3943  *
3944  * @vif_cfg_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to interface
3945  *	(MLD) parameters from &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg that vary during the
3946  *	lifetime of the interface (e.g. assoc status, IP addresses, etc.)
3947  *	The @changed parameter indicates which value changed.
3948  *	The callback can sleep.
3949  *
3950  * @link_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to link
3951  *	parameters from &struct ieee80211_bss_conf that are related to an
3952  *	individual link. e.g. legacy/HT/VHT/... rate information.
3953  *	The @changed parameter indicates which value changed, and the @link_id
3954  *	parameter indicates the link ID. Note that the @link_id will be 0 for
3955  *	non-MLO connections.
3956  *	The callback can sleep.
3957  *
3958  * @prepare_multicast: Prepare for multicast filter configuration.
3959  *	This callback is optional, and its return value is passed
3960  *	to configure_filter(). This callback must be atomic.
3961  *
3962  * @configure_filter: Configure the device's RX filter.
3963  *	See the section "Frame filtering" for more information.
3964  *	This callback must be implemented and can sleep.
3965  *
3966  * @config_iface_filter: Configure the interface's RX filter.
3967  *	This callback is optional and is used to configure which frames
3968  *	should be passed to mac80211. The filter_flags is the combination
3969  *	of FIF_* flags. The changed_flags is a bit mask that indicates
3970  *	which flags are changed.
3971  *	This callback can sleep.
3972  *
3973  * @set_tim: Set TIM bit. mac80211 calls this function when a TIM bit
3974  * 	must be set or cleared for a given STA. Must be atomic.
3975  *
3976  * @set_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3977  *	This callback is only called between add_interface and
3978  *	remove_interface calls, i.e. while the given virtual interface
3979  *	is enabled.
3980  *	Returns a negative error code if the key can't be added.
3981  *	The callback can sleep.
3982  *
3983  * @update_tkip_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3984  * 	This callback will be called in the context of Rx. Called for drivers
3985  * 	which set IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_TKIP_REQ_RX_P1_KEY.
3986  *	The callback must be atomic.
3987  *
3988  * @set_rekey_data: If the device supports GTK rekeying, for example while the
3989  *	host is suspended, it can assign this callback to retrieve the data
3990  *	necessary to do GTK rekeying, this is the KEK, KCK and replay counter.
3991  *	After rekeying was done it should (for example during resume) notify
3992  *	userspace of the new replay counter using ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify().
3993  *
3994  * @set_default_unicast_key: Set the default (unicast) key index, useful for
3995  *	WEP when the device sends data packets autonomously, e.g. for ARP
3996  *	offloading. The index can be 0-3, or -1 for unsetting it.
3997  *
3998  * @hw_scan: Ask the hardware to service the scan request, no need to start
3999  *	the scan state machine in stack. The scan must honour the channel
4000  *	configuration done by the regulatory agent in the wiphy's
4001  *	registered bands. The hardware (or the driver) needs to make sure
4002  *	that power save is disabled.
4003  *	The @req ie/ie_len members are rewritten by mac80211 to contain the
4004  *	entire IEs after the SSID, so that drivers need not look at these
4005  *	at all but just send them after the SSID -- mac80211 includes the
4006  *	(extended) supported rates and HT information (where applicable).
4007  *	When the scan finishes, ieee80211_scan_completed() must be called;
4008  *	note that it also must be called when the scan cannot finish due to
4009  *	any error unless this callback returned a negative error code.
4010  *	This callback is also allowed to return the special return value 1,
4011  *	this indicates that hardware scan isn't desirable right now and a
4012  *	software scan should be done instead. A driver wishing to use this
4013  *	capability must ensure its (hardware) scan capabilities aren't
4014  *	advertised as more capable than mac80211's software scan is.
4015  *	The callback can sleep.
4016  *
4017  * @cancel_hw_scan: Ask the low-level tp cancel the active hw scan.
4018  *	The driver should ask the hardware to cancel the scan (if possible),
4019  *	but the scan will be completed only after the driver will call
4020  *	ieee80211_scan_completed().
4021  *	This callback is needed for wowlan, to prevent enqueueing a new
4022  *	scan_work after the low-level driver was already suspended.
4023  *	The callback can sleep.
4024  *
4025  * @sched_scan_start: Ask the hardware to start scanning repeatedly at
4026  *	specific intervals.  The driver must call the
4027  *	ieee80211_sched_scan_results() function whenever it finds results.
4028  *	This process will continue until sched_scan_stop is called.
4029  *
4030  * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the hardware to stop an ongoing scheduled scan.
4031  *	In this case, ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped() must not be called.
4032  *
4033  * @sw_scan_start: Notifier function that is called just before a software scan
4034  *	is started. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need this notification.
4035  *	The mac_addr parameter allows supporting NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR,
4036  *	the driver may set the NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR flag if it
4037  *	can use this parameter. The callback can sleep.
4038  *
4039  * @sw_scan_complete: Notifier function that is called just after a
4040  *	software scan finished. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need
4041  *	this notification.
4042  *	The callback can sleep.
4043  *
4044  * @get_stats: Return low-level statistics.
4045  * 	Returns zero if statistics are available.
4046  *	The callback can sleep.
4047  *
4048  * @get_key_seq: If your device implements encryption in hardware and does
4049  *	IV/PN assignment then this callback should be provided to read the
4050  *	IV/PN for the given key from hardware.
4051  *	The callback must be atomic.
4052  *
4053  * @set_frag_threshold: Configuration of fragmentation threshold. Assign this
4054  *	if the device does fragmentation by itself. Note that to prevent the
4055  *	stack from doing fragmentation IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG
4056  *	should be set as well.
4057  *	The callback can sleep.
4058  *
4059  * @set_rts_threshold: Configuration of RTS threshold (if device needs it)
4060  *	The callback can sleep.
4061  *
4062  * @sta_add: Notifies low level driver about addition of an associated station,
4063  *	AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. This callback can sleep.
4064  *
4065  * @sta_remove: Notifies low level driver about removal of an associated
4066  *	station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. Note that after the callback
4067  *	returns it isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected;
4068  *	no RCU grace period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing
4069  *	the station. See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
4070  *	This callback can sleep.
4071  *
4072  * @vif_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add a debugfs vif
4073  *	directory with its files. This callback should be within a
4074  *	CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This callback can sleep.
4075  *
4076  * @link_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
4077  *	when a link is added to a mac80211 vif. This callback should be within
4078  *	a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This callback can sleep.
4079  *	For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the default bss_conf
4080  *	with the vif's directory rather than a separate subdirectory.
4081  *
4082  * @sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
4083  *	when a station is added to mac80211's station list. This callback
4084  *	should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
4085  *	callback can sleep.
4086  *
4087  * @link_sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
4088  *	when a link is added to a mac80211 station. This callback
4089  *	should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
4090  *	callback can sleep.
4091  *	For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the deflink with the
4092  *	station's directory rather than a separate subdirectory.
4093  *
4094  * @sta_notify: Notifies low level driver about power state transition of an
4095  *	associated station, AP,  IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. For a VIF operating
4096  *	in AP mode, this callback will not be called when the flag
4097  *	%IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS is set. Must be atomic.
4098  *
4099  * @sta_set_txpwr: Configure the station tx power. This callback set the tx
4100  *	power for the station.
4101  *	This callback can sleep.
4102  *
4103  * @sta_state: Notifies low level driver about state transition of a
4104  *	station (which can be the AP, a client, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc.)
4105  *	This callback is mutually exclusive with @sta_add/@sta_remove.
4106  *	It must not fail for down transitions but may fail for transitions
4107  *	up the list of states. Also note that after the callback returns it
4108  *	isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected - no RCU grace
4109  *	period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing the station.
4110  *	See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
4111  *	The callback can sleep.
4112  *
4113  * @sta_pre_rcu_remove: Notify driver about station removal before RCU
4114  *	synchronisation. This is useful if a driver needs to have station
4115  *	pointers protected using RCU, it can then use this call to clear
4116  *	the pointers instead of waiting for an RCU grace period to elapse
4117  *	in @sta_state.
4118  *	The callback can sleep.
4119  *
4120  * @link_sta_rc_update: Notifies the driver of changes to the bitrates that can
4121  *	be used to transmit to the station. The changes are advertised with bits
4122  *	from &enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed and the values are reflected
4123  *	in the station data. This callback should only be used when the driver
4124  *	uses hardware rate control (%IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL) since
4125  *	otherwise the rate control algorithm is notified directly.
4126  *	Must be atomic.
4127  * @sta_rate_tbl_update: Notifies the driver that the rate table changed. This
4128  *	is only used if the configured rate control algorithm actually uses
4129  *	the new rate table API, and is therefore optional. Must be atomic.
4130  *
4131  * @sta_statistics: Get statistics for this station. For example with beacon
4132  *	filtering, the statistics kept by mac80211 might not be accurate, so
4133  *	let the driver pre-fill the statistics. The driver can fill most of
4134  *	the values (indicating which by setting the filled bitmap), but not
4135  *	all of them make sense - see the source for which ones are possible.
4136  *	Statistics that the driver doesn't fill will be filled by mac80211.
4137  *	The callback can sleep.
4138  *
4139  * @link_sta_statistics: Get link statistics for this station. For example with
4140  *	beacon filtering, the statistics kept by mac80211 might not be
4141  *	accurate, so let the driver pre-fill the statistics. The driver can
4142  *	fill most of the values (indicating which by setting the filled
4143  *	bitmap), but not all of them make sense - see the source for which
4144  *	ones are possible.
4145  *	Statistics that the driver doesn't fill will be filled by mac80211.
4146  *	The callback can sleep.
4147  *
4148  * @conf_tx: Configure TX queue parameters (EDCF (aifs, cw_min, cw_max),
4149  *	bursting) for a hardware TX queue.
4150  *	Returns a negative error code on failure.
4151  *	The callback can sleep.
4152  *
4153  * @get_tsf: Get the current TSF timer value from firmware/hardware. Currently,
4154  *	this is only used for IBSS mode BSSID merging and debugging. Is not a
4155  *	required function.
4156  *	The callback can sleep.
4157  *
4158  * @set_tsf: Set the TSF timer to the specified value in the firmware/hardware.
4159  *	Currently, this is only used for IBSS mode debugging. Is not a
4160  *	required function.
4161  *	The callback can sleep.
4162  *
4163  * @offset_tsf: Offset the TSF timer by the specified value in the
4164  *	firmware/hardware.  Preferred to set_tsf as it avoids delay between
4165  *	calling set_tsf() and hardware getting programmed, which will show up
4166  *	as TSF delay. Is not a required function.
4167  *	The callback can sleep.
4168  *
4169  * @reset_tsf: Reset the TSF timer and allow firmware/hardware to synchronize
4170  *	with other STAs in the IBSS. This is only used in IBSS mode. This
4171  *	function is optional if the firmware/hardware takes full care of
4172  *	TSF synchronization.
4173  *	The callback can sleep.
4174  *
4175  * @tx_last_beacon: Determine whether the last IBSS beacon was sent by us.
4176  *	This is needed only for IBSS mode and the result of this function is
4177  *	used to determine whether to reply to Probe Requests.
4178  *	Returns non-zero if this device sent the last beacon.
4179  *	The callback can sleep.
4180  *
4181  * @get_survey: Return per-channel survey information
4182  *
4183  * @rfkill_poll: Poll rfkill hardware state. If you need this, you also
4184  *	need to set wiphy->rfkill_poll to %true before registration,
4185  *	and need to call wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state() in the callback.
4186  *	The callback can sleep.
4187  *
4188  * @set_coverage_class: Set slot time for given coverage class as specified
4189  *	in IEEE 802.11-2007 section 17.3.8.6 and modify ACK timeout
4190  *	accordingly; coverage class equals to -1 to enable ACK timeout
4191  *	estimation algorithm (dynack). To disable dynack set valid value for
4192  *	coverage class. This callback is not required and may sleep.
4193  *
4194  * @testmode_cmd: Implement a cfg80211 test mode command. The passed @vif may
4195  *	be %NULL. The callback can sleep.
4196  * @testmode_dump: Implement a cfg80211 test mode dump. The callback can sleep.
4197  *
4198  * @flush: Flush all pending frames from the hardware queue, making sure
4199  *	that the hardware queues are empty. The @queues parameter is a bitmap
4200  *	of queues to flush, which is useful if different virtual interfaces
4201  *	use different hardware queues; it may also indicate all queues.
4202  *	If the parameter @drop is set to %true, pending frames may be dropped.
4203  *	Note that vif can be NULL.
4204  *	The callback can sleep.
4205  *
4206  * @flush_sta: Flush or drop all pending frames from the hardware queue(s) for
4207  *	the given station, as it's about to be removed.
4208  *	The callback can sleep.
4209  *
4210  * @channel_switch: Drivers that need (or want) to offload the channel
4211  *	switch operation for CSAs received from the AP may implement this
4212  *	callback. They must then call ieee80211_chswitch_done() to indicate
4213  *	completion of the channel switch.
4214  *
4215  * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
4216  *	Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
4217  *	reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
4218  *	(also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
4219  *
4220  * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
4221  *
4222  * @remain_on_channel: Starts an off-channel period on the given channel, must
4223  *	call back to ieee80211_ready_on_channel() when on that channel. Note
4224  *	that normal channel traffic is not stopped as this is intended for hw
4225  *	offload. Frames to transmit on the off-channel channel are transmitted
4226  *	normally except for the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN flag. When the
4227  *	duration (which will always be non-zero) expires, the driver must call
4228  *	ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired().
4229  *	Note that this callback may be called while the device is in IDLE and
4230  *	must be accepted in this case.
4231  *	This callback may sleep.
4232  * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Requests that an ongoing off-channel period is
4233  *	aborted before it expires. This callback may sleep.
4234  *
4235  * @set_ringparam: Set tx and rx ring sizes.
4236  *
4237  * @get_ringparam: Get tx and rx ring current and maximum sizes.
4238  *
4239  * @tx_frames_pending: Check if there is any pending frame in the hardware
4240  *	queues before entering power save.
4241  *
4242  * @set_bitrate_mask: Set a mask of rates to be used for rate control selection
4243  *	when transmitting a frame. Currently only legacy rates are handled.
4244  *	The callback can sleep.
4245  * @event_callback: Notify driver about any event in mac80211. See
4246  *	&enum ieee80211_event_type for the different types.
4247  *	The callback must be atomic.
4248  *
4249  * @release_buffered_frames: Release buffered frames according to the given
4250  *	parameters. In the case where the driver buffers some frames for
4251  *	sleeping stations mac80211 will use this callback to tell the driver
4252  *	to release some frames, either for PS-poll or uAPSD.
4253  *	Note that if the @more_data parameter is %false the driver must check
4254  *	if there are more frames on the given TIDs, and if there are more than
4255  *	the frames being released then it must still set the more-data bit in
4256  *	the frame. If the @more_data parameter is %true, then of course the
4257  *	more-data bit must always be set.
4258  *	The @tids parameter tells the driver which TIDs to release frames
4259  *	from, for PS-poll it will always have only a single bit set.
4260  *	In the case this is used for a PS-poll initiated release, the
4261  *	@num_frames parameter will always be 1 so code can be shared. In
4262  *	this case the driver must also set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
4263  *	on the TX status (and must report TX status) so that the PS-poll
4264  *	period is properly ended. This is used to avoid sending multiple
4265  *	responses for a retried PS-poll frame.
4266  *	In the case this is used for uAPSD, the @num_frames parameter may be
4267  *	bigger than one, but the driver may send fewer frames (it must send
4268  *	at least one, however). In this case it is also responsible for
4269  *	setting the EOSP flag in the QoS header of the frames. Also, when the
4270  *	service period ends, the driver must set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP
4271  *	on the last frame in the SP. Alternatively, it may call the function
4272  *	ieee80211_sta_eosp() to inform mac80211 of the end of the SP.
4273  *	This callback must be atomic.
4274  * @allow_buffered_frames: Prepare device to allow the given number of frames
4275  *	to go out to the given station. The frames will be sent by mac80211
4276  *	via the usual TX path after this call. The TX information for frames
4277  *	released will also have the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER flag set
4278  *	and the last one will also have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set. In case
4279  *	frames from multiple TIDs are released and the driver might reorder
4280  *	them between the TIDs, it must set the %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
4281  *	on the last frame and clear it on all others and also handle the EOSP
4282  *	bit in the QoS header correctly. Alternatively, it can also call the
4283  *	ieee80211_sta_eosp() function.
4284  *	The @tids parameter is a bitmap and tells the driver which TIDs the
4285  *	frames will be on; it will at most have two bits set.
4286  *	This callback must be atomic.
4287  *
4288  * @get_et_sset_count:  Ethtool API to get string-set count.
4289  *	Note that the wiphy mutex is not held for this callback since it's
4290  *	expected to return a static value.
4291  *
4292  * @get_et_stats:  Ethtool API to get a set of u64 stats.
4293  *
4294  * @get_et_strings:  Ethtool API to get a set of strings to describe stats
4295  *	and perhaps other supported types of ethtool data-sets.
4296  *	Note that the wiphy mutex is not held for this callback since it's
4297  *	expected to return a static value.
4298  *
4299  * @mgd_prepare_tx: Prepare for transmitting a management frame for association
4300  *	before associated. In multi-channel scenarios, a virtual interface is
4301  *	bound to a channel before it is associated, but as it isn't associated
4302  *	yet it need not necessarily be given airtime, in particular since any
4303  *	transmission to a P2P GO needs to be synchronized against the GO's
4304  *	powersave state. mac80211 will call this function before transmitting a
4305  *	management frame prior to transmitting that frame to allow the driver
4306  *	to give it channel time for the transmission, to get a response and be
4307  *	able to synchronize with the GO.
4308  *	The callback will be called before each transmission and upon return
4309  *	mac80211 will transmit the frame right away.
4310  *	Additional information is passed in the &struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info
4311  *	data. If duration there is greater than zero, mac80211 hints to the
4312  *	driver the duration for which the operation is requested.
4313  *	The callback is optional and can (should!) sleep.
4314  * @mgd_complete_tx: Notify the driver that the response frame for a previously
4315  *	transmitted frame announced with @mgd_prepare_tx was received, the data
4316  *	is filled similarly to @mgd_prepare_tx though the duration is not used.
4317  *	Note that this isn't always called for each mgd_prepare_tx() call, for
4318  *	example for SAE the 'confirm' messages can be on the air in any order.
4319  *
4320  * @mgd_protect_tdls_discover: Protect a TDLS discovery session. After sending
4321  *	a TDLS discovery-request, we expect a reply to arrive on the AP's
4322  *	channel. We must stay on the channel (no PSM, scan, etc.), since a TDLS
4323  *	setup-response is a direct packet not buffered by the AP.
4324  *	mac80211 will call this function just before the transmission of a TDLS
4325  *	discovery-request. The recommended period of protection is at least
4326  *	2 * (DTIM period).
4327  *	The callback is optional and can sleep.
4328  *
4329  * @add_chanctx: Notifies device driver about new channel context creation.
4330  *	This callback may sleep.
4331  * @remove_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context destruction.
4332  *	This callback may sleep.
4333  * @change_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context changes that
4334  *	may happen when combining different virtual interfaces on the same
4335  *	channel context with different settings
4336  *	This callback may sleep.
4337  * @assign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being bound
4338  *	to vif. Possible use is for hw queue remapping.
4339  *	This callback may sleep.
4340  * @unassign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being
4341  *	unbound from vif.
4342  *	This callback may sleep.
4343  * @switch_vif_chanctx: switch a number of vifs from one chanctx to
4344  *	another, as specified in the list of
4345  *	@ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch passed to the driver, according
4346  *	to the mode defined in &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode.
4347  *	This callback may sleep.
4348  *
4349  * @start_ap: Start operation on the AP interface, this is called after all the
4350  *	information in bss_conf is set and beacon can be retrieved. A channel
4351  *	context is bound before this is called. Note that if the driver uses
4352  *	software scan or ROC, this (and @stop_ap) isn't called when the AP is
4353  *	just "paused" for scanning/ROC, which is indicated by the beacon being
4354  *	disabled/enabled via @bss_info_changed.
4355  * @stop_ap: Stop operation on the AP interface.
4356  *
4357  * @reconfig_complete: Called after a call to ieee80211_restart_hw() and
4358  *	during resume, when the reconfiguration has completed.
4359  *	This can help the driver implement the reconfiguration step (and
4360  *	indicate mac80211 is ready to receive frames).
4361  *	This callback may sleep.
4362  *
4363  * @ipv6_addr_change: IPv6 address assignment on the given interface changed.
4364  *	Currently, this is only called for managed or P2P client interfaces.
4365  *	This callback is optional; it must not sleep.
4366  *
4367  * @channel_switch_beacon: Starts a channel switch to a new channel.
4368  *	Beacons are modified to include CSA or ECSA IEs before calling this
4369  *	function. The corresponding count fields in these IEs must be
4370  *	decremented, and when they reach 1 the driver must call
4371  *	ieee80211_csa_finish(). Drivers which use ieee80211_beacon_get()
4372  *	get the csa counter decremented by mac80211, but must check if it is
4373  *	1 using ieee80211_beacon_counter_is_complete() after the beacon has been
4374  *	transmitted and then call ieee80211_csa_finish().
4375  *	If the CSA count starts as zero or 1, this function will not be called,
4376  *	since there won't be any time to beacon before the switch anyway.
4377  * @pre_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4378  *	before a channel switch procedure is started (ie. when a STA
4379  *	gets a CSA or a userspace initiated channel-switch), allowing
4380  *	the driver to prepare for the channel switch.
4381  * @post_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4382  *	after a channel switch procedure is completed, allowing the
4383  *	driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4384  * @abort_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4385  *	when channel switch procedure was aborted, allowing the
4386  *	driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4387  * @channel_switch_rx_beacon: This is an optional callback that is called
4388  *	when channel switch procedure is in progress and additional beacon with
4389  *	CSA IE was received, allowing driver to track changes in count.
4390  * @join_ibss: Join an IBSS (on an IBSS interface); this is called after all
4391  *	information in bss_conf is set up and the beacon can be retrieved. A
4392  *	channel context is bound before this is called.
4393  * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS again.
4394  *
4395  * @get_expected_throughput: extract the expected throughput towards the
4396  *	specified station. The returned value is expressed in Kbps. It returns 0
4397  *	if the RC algorithm does not have proper data to provide.
4398  *
4399  * @get_txpower: get current maximum tx power (in dBm) based on configuration
4400  *	and hardware limits.
4401  *
4402  * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
4403  *	is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
4404  *	and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP. The
4405  *	driver receives a channel-switch request template and the location of
4406  *	the switch-timing IE within the template as part of the invocation.
4407  *	The template is valid only within the call, and the driver can
4408  *	optionally copy the skb for further re-use.
4409  * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
4410  *	peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
4411  * @tdls_recv_channel_switch: a TDLS channel-switch related frame (request or
4412  *	response) has been received from a remote peer. The driver gets
4413  *	parameters parsed from the incoming frame and may use them to continue
4414  *	an ongoing channel-switch operation. In addition, a channel-switch
4415  *	response template is provided, together with the location of the
4416  *	switch-timing IE within the template. The skb can only be used within
4417  *	the function call.
4418  *
4419  * @wake_tx_queue: Called when new packets have been added to the queue.
4420  * @sync_rx_queues: Process all pending frames in RSS queues. This is a
4421  *	synchronization which is needed in case driver has in its RSS queues
4422  *	pending frames that were received prior to the control path action
4423  *	currently taken (e.g. disassociation) but are not processed yet.
4424  *
4425  * @start_nan: join an existing NAN cluster, or create a new one.
4426  * @stop_nan: leave the NAN cluster.
4427  * @nan_change_conf: change NAN configuration. The data in cfg80211_nan_conf
4428  *	contains full new configuration and changes specify which parameters
4429  *	are changed with respect to the last NAN config.
4430  *	The driver gets both full configuration and the changed parameters since
4431  *	some devices may need the full configuration while others need only the
4432  *	changed parameters.
4433  * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns 0 on success. The data in
4434  *	cfg80211_nan_func must not be referenced outside the scope of
4435  *	this call.
4436  * @del_nan_func: Remove a NAN function. The driver must call
4437  *	ieee80211_nan_func_terminated() with
4438  *	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST reason code upon removal.
4439  * @can_aggregate_in_amsdu: Called in order to determine if HW supports
4440  *	aggregating two specific frames in the same A-MSDU. The relation
4441  *	between the skbs should be symmetric and transitive. Note that while
4442  *	skb is always a real frame, head may or may not be an A-MSDU.
4443  * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available.
4444  *	Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided.
4445  *
4446  * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM) (this call can sleep)
4447  * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement (this call can sleep)
4448  * @set_tid_config: Apply TID specific configurations. This callback may sleep.
4449  * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer.
4450  *	This callback may sleep.
4451  * @update_vif_offload: Update virtual interface offload flags
4452  *	This callback may sleep.
4453  * @sta_set_4addr: Called to notify the driver when a station starts/stops using
4454  *	4-address mode
4455  * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings.
4456  * @sta_set_decap_offload: Called to notify the driver when a station is allowed
4457  *	to use rx decapsulation offload
4458  * @add_twt_setup: Update hw with TWT agreement parameters received from the peer.
4459  *	This callback allows the hw to check if requested parameters
4460  *	are supported and if there is enough room for a new agreement.
4461  *	The hw is expected to set agreement result in the req_type field of
4462  *	twt structure.
4463  * @twt_teardown_request: Update the hw with TWT teardown request received
4464  *	from the peer.
4465  * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for
4466  *	radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit
4467  *	or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev.
4468  *	Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime
4469  *	switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected
4470  *	radar channel.
4471  *	The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to
4472  *	disable background CAC/radar detection.
4473  * @net_fill_forward_path: Called from .ndo_fill_forward_path in order to
4474  *	resolve a path for hardware flow offloading
4475  * @can_activate_links: Checks if a specific active_links bitmap is
4476  *	supported by the driver.
4477  * @change_vif_links: Change the valid links on an interface, note that while
4478  *	removing the old link information is still valid (link_conf pointer),
4479  *	but may immediately disappear after the function returns. The old or
4480  *	new links bitmaps may be 0 if going from/to a non-MLO situation.
4481  *	The @old array contains pointers to the old bss_conf structures
4482  *	that were already removed, in case they're needed.
4483  *	Note that removal of link should always succeed, so the return value
4484  *	will be ignored in a removal only case.
4485  *	This callback can sleep.
4486  * @change_sta_links: Change the valid links of a station, similar to
4487  *	@change_vif_links. This callback can sleep.
4488  *	Note that a sta can also be inserted or removed with valid links,
4489  *	i.e. passed to @sta_add/@sta_state with sta->valid_links not zero.
4490  *	In fact, cannot change from having valid_links and not having them.
4491  * @set_hw_timestamp: Enable/disable HW timestamping of TM/FTM frames. This is
4492  *	not restored at HW reset by mac80211 so drivers need to take care of
4493  *	that.
4494  * @net_setup_tc: Called from .ndo_setup_tc in order to prepare hardware
4495  *	flow offloading for flows originating from the vif.
4496  *	Note that the driver must not assume that the vif driver_data is valid
4497  *	at this point, since the callback can be called during netdev teardown.
4498  * @can_neg_ttlm: for managed interface, requests the driver to determine
4499  *	if the requested TID-To-Link mapping can be accepted or not.
4500  *	If it's not accepted the driver may suggest a preferred mapping and
4501  *	modify @ttlm parameter with the suggested TID-to-Link mapping.
4502  * @prep_add_interface: prepare for interface addition. This can be used by
4503  *      drivers to prepare for the addition of a new interface, e.g., allocate
4504  *      the needed resources etc. This callback doesn't guarantee that an
4505  *      interface with the specified type would be added, and thus drivers that
4506  *      implement this callback need to handle such cases. The type is the full
4507  *      &enum nl80211_iftype.
4508  */
4509 struct ieee80211_ops {
4510 	void (*tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4511 		   struct ieee80211_tx_control *control,
4512 		   struct sk_buff *skb);
4513 	int (*start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4514 	void (*stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool suspend);
4515 #ifdef CONFIG_PM
4516 	int (*suspend)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan);
4517 	int (*resume)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4518 	void (*set_wakeup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool enabled);
4519 #endif
4520 	int (*add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4521 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4522 	int (*change_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4523 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4524 				enum nl80211_iftype new_type, bool p2p);
4525 	void (*remove_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4526 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4527 	int (*config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int radio_idx, u32 changed);
4528 	void (*bss_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4529 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4530 				 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4531 				 u64 changed);
4532 	void (*vif_cfg_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4533 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4534 				u64 changed);
4535 	void (*link_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4536 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4537 				  struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4538 				  u64 changed);
4539 
4540 	int (*start_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4541 			struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4542 	void (*stop_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4543 			struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4544 
4545 	u64 (*prepare_multicast)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4546 				 struct netdev_hw_addr_list *mc_list);
4547 	void (*configure_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4548 				 unsigned int changed_flags,
4549 				 unsigned int *total_flags,
4550 				 u64 multicast);
4551 	void (*config_iface_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4552 				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4553 				    unsigned int filter_flags,
4554 				    unsigned int changed_flags);
4555 	int (*set_tim)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4556 		       bool set);
4557 	int (*set_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, enum set_key_cmd cmd,
4558 		       struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4559 		       struct ieee80211_key_conf *key);
4560 	void (*update_tkip_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4561 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4562 				struct ieee80211_key_conf *conf,
4563 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4564 				u32 iv32, u16 *phase1key);
4565 	void (*set_rekey_data)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4566 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4567 			       struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
4568 	void (*set_default_unicast_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4569 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int idx);
4570 	int (*hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4571 		       struct ieee80211_scan_request *req);
4572 	void (*cancel_hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4573 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4574 	int (*sched_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4575 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4576 				struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *req,
4577 				struct ieee80211_scan_ies *ies);
4578 	int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4579 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4580 	void (*sw_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4581 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4582 			      const u8 *mac_addr);
4583 	void (*sw_scan_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4584 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4585 	int (*get_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4586 			 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats *stats);
4587 	void (*get_key_seq)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4588 			    struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
4589 			    struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
4590 	int (*set_frag_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int radio_idx,
4591 				  u32 value);
4592 	int (*set_rts_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int radio_idx,
4593 				 u32 value);
4594 	int (*sta_add)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4595 		       struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4596 	int (*sta_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4597 			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4598 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
4599 	void (*vif_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4600 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4601 	void (*link_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4602 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4603 				 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4604 				 struct dentry *dir);
4605 	void (*sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4606 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4607 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4608 				struct dentry *dir);
4609 	void (*link_sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4610 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4611 				     struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
4612 				     struct dentry *dir);
4613 #endif
4614 	void (*sta_notify)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4615 			enum sta_notify_cmd, struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4616 	int (*sta_set_txpwr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4617 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4618 			     struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4619 	int (*sta_state)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4620 			 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4621 			 enum ieee80211_sta_state old_state,
4622 			 enum ieee80211_sta_state new_state);
4623 	void (*sta_pre_rcu_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4624 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4625 				   struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4626 	void (*link_sta_rc_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4627 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4628 				   struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
4629 				   u32 changed);
4630 	void (*sta_rate_tbl_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4631 				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4632 				    struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4633 	void (*sta_statistics)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4634 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4635 			       struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4636 			       struct station_info *sinfo);
4637 	int (*conf_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4638 		       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4639 		       unsigned int link_id, u16 ac,
4640 		       const struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params *params);
4641 	u64 (*get_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4642 	void (*set_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4643 			u64 tsf);
4644 	void (*offset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4645 			   s64 offset);
4646 	void (*reset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4647 	int (*tx_last_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4648 	void (*link_sta_statistics)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4649 				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4650 				    struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
4651 				    struct link_station_info *link_sinfo);
4652 
4653 	/**
4654 	 * @ampdu_action:
4655 	 * Perform a certain A-MPDU action.
4656 	 * The RA/TID combination determines the destination and TID we want
4657 	 * the ampdu action to be performed for. The action is defined through
4658 	 * ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
4659 	 * When the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL the driver
4660 	 * may neither send aggregates containing more subframes than @buf_size
4661 	 * nor send aggregates in a way that lost frames would exceed the
4662 	 * buffer size. If just limiting the aggregate size, this would be
4663 	 * possible with a buf_size of 8:
4664 	 *
4665 	 * - ``TX: 1.....7``
4666 	 * - ``RX:  2....7`` (lost frame #1)
4667 	 * - ``TX:        8..1...``
4668 	 *
4669 	 * which is invalid since #1 was now re-transmitted well past the
4670 	 * buffer size of 8. Correct ways to retransmit #1 would be:
4671 	 *
4672 	 * - ``TX:        1   or``
4673 	 * - ``TX:        18  or``
4674 	 * - ``TX:        81``
4675 	 *
4676 	 * Even ``189`` would be wrong since 1 could be lost again.
4677 	 *
4678 	 * Returns a negative error code on failure. The driver may return
4679 	 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE for %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START
4680 	 * if the session can start immediately.
4681 	 *
4682 	 * The callback can sleep.
4683 	 */
4684 	int (*ampdu_action)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4685 			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4686 			    struct ieee80211_ampdu_params *params);
4687 	int (*get_survey)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int idx,
4688 		struct survey_info *survey);
4689 	void (*rfkill_poll)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4690 	void (*set_coverage_class)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int radio_idx,
4691 				   s16 coverage_class);
4692 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
4693 	int (*testmode_cmd)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4694 			    void *data, int len);
4695 	int (*testmode_dump)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb,
4696 			     struct netlink_callback *cb,
4697 			     void *data, int len);
4698 #endif
4699 	void (*flush)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4700 		      u32 queues, bool drop);
4701 	void (*flush_sta)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4702 			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4703 	void (*channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4704 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4705 			       struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4706 	int (*set_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int radio_idx,
4707 			   u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
4708 	int (*get_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int radio_idx,
4709 			   u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
4710 
4711 	int (*remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4712 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4713 				 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
4714 				 int duration,
4715 				 enum ieee80211_roc_type type);
4716 	int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4717 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4718 	int (*set_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx, u32 rx);
4719 	void (*get_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4720 			      u32 *tx, u32 *tx_max, u32 *rx, u32 *rx_max);
4721 	bool (*tx_frames_pending)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4722 	int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4723 				const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
4724 	void (*event_callback)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4725 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4726 			       const struct ieee80211_event *event);
4727 
4728 	void (*allow_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4729 				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4730 				      u16 tids, int num_frames,
4731 				      enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4732 				      bool more_data);
4733 	void (*release_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4734 					struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4735 					u16 tids, int num_frames,
4736 					enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4737 					bool more_data);
4738 
4739 	int	(*get_et_sset_count)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4740 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int sset);
4741 	void	(*get_et_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4742 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4743 				struct ethtool_stats *stats, u64 *data);
4744 	void	(*get_et_strings)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4745 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4746 				  u32 sset, u8 *data);
4747 
4748 	void	(*mgd_prepare_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4749 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4750 				  struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4751 	void	(*mgd_complete_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4752 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4753 				   struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4754 
4755 	void	(*mgd_protect_tdls_discover)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4756 					     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4757 					     unsigned int link_id);
4758 
4759 	int (*add_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4760 			   struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4761 	void (*remove_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4762 			       struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4763 	void (*change_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4764 			       struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx,
4765 			       u32 changed);
4766 	int (*assign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4767 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4768 				  struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4769 				  struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4770 	void (*unassign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4771 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4772 				     struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4773 				     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4774 	int (*switch_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4775 				  struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs,
4776 				  int n_vifs,
4777 				  enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode);
4778 
4779 	void (*reconfig_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4780 				  enum ieee80211_reconfig_type reconfig_type);
4781 
4782 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_IPV6)
4783 	void (*ipv6_addr_change)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4784 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4785 				 struct inet6_dev *idev);
4786 #endif
4787 	void (*channel_switch_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4788 				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4789 				      struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4790 	int (*pre_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4791 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4792 				  struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4793 
4794 	int (*post_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4795 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4796 				   struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4797 	void (*abort_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4798 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4799 				     struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4800 	void (*channel_switch_rx_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4801 					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4802 					 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4803 
4804 	int (*join_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4805 	void (*leave_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4806 	u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4807 				       struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4808 	int (*get_txpower)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4809 			   unsigned int link_id, int *dbm);
4810 
4811 	int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4812 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4813 				   struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 oper_class,
4814 				   struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
4815 				   struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb, u32 ch_sw_tm_ie);
4816 	void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4817 					   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4818 					   struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4819 	void (*tdls_recv_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4820 					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4821 					 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params *params);
4822 
4823 	void (*wake_tx_queue)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4824 			      struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
4825 	void (*sync_rx_queues)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4826 
4827 	int (*start_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4828 			 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4829 			 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
4830 	int (*stop_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4831 			struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4832 	int (*nan_change_conf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4833 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4834 			       struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf, u32 changes);
4835 	int (*add_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4836 			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4837 			    const struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
4838 	void (*del_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4839 			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4840 			    u8 instance_id);
4841 	bool (*can_aggregate_in_amsdu)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4842 				       struct sk_buff *head,
4843 				       struct sk_buff *skb);
4844 	int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4845 				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4846 				       struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats);
4847 	int (*start_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4848 			  struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4849 	void (*abort_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4850 			   struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4851 	int (*set_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4852 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4853 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4854 			      struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf);
4855 	int (*reset_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4856 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4857 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tids);
4858 	void (*update_vif_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4859 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4860 	void (*sta_set_4addr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4861 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4862 	int (*set_sar_specs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4863 			     const struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar);
4864 	void (*sta_set_decap_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4865 				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4866 				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4867 	void (*add_twt_setup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4868 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4869 			      struct ieee80211_twt_setup *twt);
4870 	void (*twt_teardown_request)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4871 				     struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 flowid);
4872 	int (*set_radar_background)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4873 				    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4874 	int (*net_fill_forward_path)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4875 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4876 				     struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4877 				     struct net_device_path_ctx *ctx,
4878 				     struct net_device_path *path);
4879 	bool (*can_activate_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4880 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4881 				   u16 active_links);
4882 	int (*change_vif_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4883 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4884 				u16 old_links, u16 new_links,
4885 				struct ieee80211_bss_conf *old[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]);
4886 	int (*change_sta_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4887 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4888 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4889 				u16 old_links, u16 new_links);
4890 	int (*set_hw_timestamp)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4891 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4892 				struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp *hwts);
4893 	int (*net_setup_tc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4894 			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4895 			    struct net_device *dev,
4896 			    enum tc_setup_type type,
4897 			    void *type_data);
4898 	enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res
4899 	(*can_neg_ttlm)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4900 			struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm *ttlm);
4901 	void (*prep_add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4902 				   enum nl80211_iftype type);
4903 };
4904 
4905 /**
4906  * ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm - Allocate a new hardware device
4907  *
4908  * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4909  * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4910  * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4911  * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4912  * @priv_data_len.
4913  *
4914  * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4915  * @ops: callbacks for this device
4916  * @requested_name: Requested name for this device.
4917  *	NULL is valid value, and means use the default naming (phy%d)
4918  *
4919  * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4920  */
4921 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(size_t priv_data_len,
4922 					   const struct ieee80211_ops *ops,
4923 					   const char *requested_name);
4924 
4925 /**
4926  * ieee80211_alloc_hw - Allocate a new hardware device
4927  *
4928  * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4929  * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4930  * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4931  * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4932  * @priv_data_len.
4933  *
4934  * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4935  * @ops: callbacks for this device
4936  *
4937  * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4938  */
4939 static inline
ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,const struct ieee80211_ops * ops)4940 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,
4941 					const struct ieee80211_ops *ops)
4942 {
4943 	return ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(priv_data_len, ops, NULL);
4944 }
4945 
4946 /**
4947  * ieee80211_register_hw - Register hardware device
4948  *
4949  * You must call this function before any other functions in
4950  * mac80211. Note that before a hardware can be registered, you
4951  * need to fill the contained wiphy's information.
4952  *
4953  * @hw: the device to register as returned by ieee80211_alloc_hw()
4954  *
4955  * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
4956  */
4957 int ieee80211_register_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4958 
4959 /**
4960  * struct ieee80211_tpt_blink - throughput blink description
4961  * @throughput: throughput in Kbit/sec
4962  * @blink_time: blink time in milliseconds
4963  *	(full cycle, ie. one off + one on period)
4964  */
4965 struct ieee80211_tpt_blink {
4966 	int throughput;
4967 	int blink_time;
4968 };
4969 
4970 /**
4971  * enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags - throughput trigger flags
4972  * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO: enable blinking with radio
4973  * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK: enable blinking when working
4974  * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED: enable blinking when at least one
4975  *	interface is connected in some way, including being an AP
4976  */
4977 enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags {
4978 	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO		= BIT(0),
4979 	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK		= BIT(1),
4980 	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED	= BIT(2),
4981 };
4982 
4983 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4984 const char *__ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4985 const char *__ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4986 const char *__ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4987 const char *__ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4988 const char *
4989 __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4990 				   unsigned int flags,
4991 				   const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
4992 				   unsigned int blink_table_len);
4993 #endif
4994 /**
4995  * ieee80211_get_tx_led_name - get name of TX LED
4996  *
4997  * mac80211 creates a transmit LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4998  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4999  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
5000  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
5001  *
5002  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
5003  *
5004  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
5005  */
ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)5006 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
5007 {
5008 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
5009 	return __ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(hw);
5010 #else
5011 	return NULL;
5012 #endif
5013 }
5014 
5015 /**
5016  * ieee80211_get_rx_led_name - get name of RX LED
5017  *
5018  * mac80211 creates a receive LED trigger for each wireless hardware
5019  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
5020  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
5021  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
5022  *
5023  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
5024  *
5025  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
5026  */
ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)5027 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
5028 {
5029 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
5030 	return __ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(hw);
5031 #else
5032 	return NULL;
5033 #endif
5034 }
5035 
5036 /**
5037  * ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name - get name of association LED
5038  *
5039  * mac80211 creates a association LED trigger for each wireless hardware
5040  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
5041  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
5042  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
5043  *
5044  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
5045  *
5046  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
5047  */
ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)5048 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
5049 {
5050 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
5051 	return __ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(hw);
5052 #else
5053 	return NULL;
5054 #endif
5055 }
5056 
5057 /**
5058  * ieee80211_get_radio_led_name - get name of radio LED
5059  *
5060  * mac80211 creates a radio change LED trigger for each wireless hardware
5061  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
5062  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
5063  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
5064  *
5065  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
5066  *
5067  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
5068  */
ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)5069 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
5070 {
5071 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
5072 	return __ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(hw);
5073 #else
5074 	return NULL;
5075 #endif
5076 }
5077 
5078 /**
5079  * ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger - create throughput LED trigger
5080  * @hw: the hardware to create the trigger for
5081  * @flags: trigger flags, see &enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags
5082  * @blink_table: the blink table -- needs to be ordered by throughput
5083  * @blink_table_len: size of the blink table
5084  *
5085  * Return: %NULL (in case of error, or if no LED triggers are
5086  * configured) or the name of the new trigger.
5087  *
5088  * Note: This function must be called before ieee80211_register_hw().
5089  */
5090 static inline const char *
ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,unsigned int flags,const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink * blink_table,unsigned int blink_table_len)5091 ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, unsigned int flags,
5092 				 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
5093 				 unsigned int blink_table_len)
5094 {
5095 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
5096 	return __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(hw, flags, blink_table,
5097 						  blink_table_len);
5098 #else
5099 	return NULL;
5100 #endif
5101 }
5102 
5103 /**
5104  * ieee80211_unregister_hw - Unregister a hardware device
5105  *
5106  * This function instructs mac80211 to free allocated resources
5107  * and unregister netdevices from the networking subsystem.
5108  *
5109  * @hw: the hardware to unregister
5110  */
5111 void ieee80211_unregister_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5112 
5113 /**
5114  * ieee80211_free_hw - free hardware descriptor
5115  *
5116  * This function frees everything that was allocated, including the
5117  * private data for the driver. You must call ieee80211_unregister_hw()
5118  * before calling this function.
5119  *
5120  * @hw: the hardware to free
5121  */
5122 void ieee80211_free_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5123 
5124 /**
5125  * ieee80211_restart_hw - restart hardware completely
5126  *
5127  * Call this function when the hardware was restarted for some reason
5128  * (hardware error, ...) and the driver is unable to restore its state
5129  * by itself. mac80211 assumes that at this point the driver/hardware
5130  * is completely uninitialised and stopped, it starts the process by
5131  * calling the ->start() operation. The driver will need to reset all
5132  * internal state that it has prior to calling this function.
5133  *
5134  * @hw: the hardware to restart
5135  */
5136 void ieee80211_restart_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5137 
5138 /**
5139  * ieee80211_rx_list - receive frame and store processed skbs in a list
5140  *
5141  * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
5142  * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
5143  * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
5144  * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
5145  * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
5146  *
5147  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5148  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
5149  * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
5150  * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5151  * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5152  *
5153  * This function must be called with BHs disabled and RCU read lock
5154  *
5155  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5156  * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
5157  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5158  * @list: the destination list
5159  */
5160 void ieee80211_rx_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5161 		       struct sk_buff *skb, struct list_head *list);
5162 
5163 /**
5164  * ieee80211_rx_napi - receive frame from NAPI context
5165  *
5166  * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
5167  * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
5168  * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
5169  * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
5170  * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
5171  *
5172  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5173  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
5174  * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
5175  * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5176  * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5177  *
5178  * This function must be called with BHs disabled.
5179  *
5180  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5181  * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
5182  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5183  * @napi: the NAPI context
5184  */
5185 void ieee80211_rx_napi(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5186 		       struct sk_buff *skb, struct napi_struct *napi);
5187 
5188 /**
5189  * ieee80211_rx - receive frame
5190  *
5191  * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
5192  * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
5193  * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
5194  * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
5195  * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
5196  *
5197  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5198  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
5199  * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
5200  * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5201  * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5202  *
5203  * In process context use instead ieee80211_rx_ni().
5204  *
5205  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5206  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5207  */
ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct sk_buff * skb)5208 static inline void ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb)
5209 {
5210 	ieee80211_rx_napi(hw, NULL, skb, NULL);
5211 }
5212 
5213 /**
5214  * ieee80211_rx_irqsafe - receive frame
5215  *
5216  * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in IRQ context
5217  * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
5218  *
5219  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni() may not
5220  * be mixed for a single hardware.Must not run concurrently with
5221  * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5222  *
5223  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5224  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5225  */
5226 void ieee80211_rx_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
5227 
5228 /**
5229  * ieee80211_rx_ni - receive frame (in process context)
5230  *
5231  * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in process context
5232  * (internally disables bottom halves).
5233  *
5234  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may
5235  * not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5236  * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5237  *
5238  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5239  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5240  */
ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct sk_buff * skb)5241 static inline void ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5242 				   struct sk_buff *skb)
5243 {
5244 	local_bh_disable();
5245 	ieee80211_rx(hw, skb);
5246 	local_bh_enable();
5247 }
5248 
5249 /**
5250  * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition - PS transition for connected sta
5251  *
5252  * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS
5253  * flag set, use this function to inform mac80211 about a connected station
5254  * entering/leaving PS mode.
5255  *
5256  * This function may not be called in IRQ context or with softirqs enabled.
5257  *
5258  * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized against
5259  * each other.
5260  *
5261  * @sta: currently connected sta
5262  * @start: start or stop PS
5263  *
5264  * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL when the requested PS mode is already set.
5265  */
5266 int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool start);
5267 
5268 /**
5269  * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni - PS transition for connected sta
5270  *                                  (in process context)
5271  *
5272  * Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() but can be called in process context
5273  * (internally disables bottom halves). Concurrent call restriction still
5274  * applies.
5275  *
5276  * @sta: currently connected sta
5277  * @start: start or stop PS
5278  *
5279  * Return: Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition().
5280  */
ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta * sta,bool start)5281 static inline int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5282 						  bool start)
5283 {
5284 	int ret;
5285 
5286 	local_bh_disable();
5287 	ret = ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(sta, start);
5288 	local_bh_enable();
5289 
5290 	return ret;
5291 }
5292 
5293 /**
5294  * ieee80211_sta_pspoll - PS-Poll frame received
5295  * @sta: currently connected station
5296  *
5297  * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
5298  * use this function to inform mac80211 that a PS-Poll frame from a
5299  * connected station was received.
5300  * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
5301  * and possibly ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(); calls to all three must
5302  * be serialized.
5303  */
5304 void ieee80211_sta_pspoll(struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
5305 
5306 /**
5307  * ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger - (potential) U-APSD trigger frame received
5308  * @sta: currently connected station
5309  * @tid: TID of the received (potential) trigger frame
5310  *
5311  * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
5312  * use this function to inform mac80211 that a (potential) trigger frame
5313  * from a connected station was received.
5314  * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
5315  * and possibly ieee80211_sta_pspoll(); calls to all three must be
5316  * serialized.
5317  * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS can be passed as the tid if the tid is unknown.
5318  * In this case, mac80211 will not check that this tid maps to an AC
5319  * that is trigger enabled and assume that the caller did the proper
5320  * checks.
5321  */
5322 void ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
5323 
5324 /*
5325  * The TX headroom reserved by mac80211 for its own tx_status functions.
5326  * This is enough for the radiotap header.
5327  */
5328 #define IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_HEADROOM	ALIGN(14, 4)
5329 
5330 /**
5331  * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered - inform mac80211 about driver-buffered frames
5332  * @sta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer for the sleeping station
5333  * @tid: the TID that has buffered frames
5334  * @buffered: indicates whether or not frames are buffered for this TID
5335  *
5336  * If a driver buffers frames for a powersave station instead of passing
5337  * them back to mac80211 for retransmission, the station may still need
5338  * to be told that there are buffered frames via the TIM bit.
5339  *
5340  * This function informs mac80211 whether or not there are frames that are
5341  * buffered in the driver for a given TID; mac80211 can then use this data
5342  * to set the TIM bit (NOTE: This may call back into the driver's set_tim
5343  * call! Beware of the locking!)
5344  *
5345  * If all frames are released to the station (due to PS-poll or uAPSD)
5346  * then the driver needs to inform mac80211 that there no longer are
5347  * frames buffered. However, when the station wakes up mac80211 assumes
5348  * that all buffered frames will be transmitted and clears this data,
5349  * drivers need to make sure they inform mac80211 about all buffered
5350  * frames on the sleep transition (sta_notify() with %STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP).
5351  *
5352  * Note that technically mac80211 only needs to know this per AC, not per
5353  * TID, but since driver buffering will inevitably happen per TID (since
5354  * it is related to aggregation) it is easier to make mac80211 map the
5355  * TID to the AC as required instead of keeping track in all drivers that
5356  * use this API.
5357  */
5358 void ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5359 				u8 tid, bool buffered);
5360 
5361 /**
5362  * ieee80211_get_tx_rates - get the selected transmit rates for a packet
5363  *
5364  * Call this function in a driver with per-packet rate selection support
5365  * to combine the rate info in the packet tx info with the most recent
5366  * rate selection table for the station entry.
5367  *
5368  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5369  * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent.
5370  * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
5371  * @dest: buffer for extracted rate/retry information
5372  * @max_rates: maximum number of rates to fetch
5373  */
5374 void ieee80211_get_tx_rates(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5375 			    struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5376 			    struct sk_buff *skb,
5377 			    struct ieee80211_tx_rate *dest,
5378 			    int max_rates);
5379 
5380 /**
5381  * ieee80211_tx_rate_update - transmit rate update callback
5382  *
5383  * Drivers should call this functions with a non-NULL pub sta
5384  * This function can be used in drivers that does not have provision
5385  * in updating the tx rate in data path.
5386  *
5387  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5388  * @pubsta: the station to update the tx rate for.
5389  * @info: tx status information
5390  */
5391 void ieee80211_tx_rate_update(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5392 			      struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
5393 			      struct ieee80211_tx_info *info);
5394 
5395 /**
5396  * ieee80211_tx_status_skb - transmit status callback
5397  *
5398  * Call this function for all transmitted frames after they have been
5399  * transmitted. It is permissible to not call this function for
5400  * multicast frames but this can affect statistics.
5401  *
5402  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5403  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls
5404  * to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe()
5405  * may not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5406  * ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni().
5407  *
5408  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5409  * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5410  */
5411 void ieee80211_tx_status_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5412 			     struct sk_buff *skb);
5413 
5414 /**
5415  * ieee80211_tx_status_ext - extended transmit status callback
5416  *
5417  * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status_skb()
5418  * in drivers that may want to provide extra information that does not
5419  * fit into &struct ieee80211_tx_info.
5420  *
5421  * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5422  * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5423  * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5424  *
5425  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5426  * @status: tx status information
5427  */
5428 void ieee80211_tx_status_ext(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5429 			     struct ieee80211_tx_status *status);
5430 
5431 /**
5432  * ieee80211_tx_status_noskb - transmit status callback without skb
5433  *
5434  * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status_skb()
5435  * in drivers that cannot reliably map tx status information back to
5436  * specific skbs.
5437  *
5438  * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5439  * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5440  * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5441  *
5442  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5443  * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent
5444  *	(NULL for multicast packets)
5445  * @info: tx status information
5446  */
ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_sta * sta,struct ieee80211_tx_info * info)5447 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5448 					     struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5449 					     struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
5450 {
5451 	struct ieee80211_tx_status status = {
5452 		.sta = sta,
5453 		.info = info,
5454 	};
5455 
5456 	ieee80211_tx_status_ext(hw, &status);
5457 }
5458 
5459 /**
5460  * ieee80211_tx_status_ni - transmit status callback (in process context)
5461  *
5462  * Like ieee80211_tx_status_skb() but can be called in process context.
5463  *
5464  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_skb() and
5465  * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed
5466  * for a single hardware.
5467  *
5468  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5469  * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5470  */
ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct sk_buff * skb)5471 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5472 					  struct sk_buff *skb)
5473 {
5474 	local_bh_disable();
5475 	ieee80211_tx_status_skb(hw, skb);
5476 	local_bh_enable();
5477 }
5478 
5479 /**
5480  * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe - IRQ-safe transmit status callback
5481  *
5482  * Like ieee80211_tx_status_skb() but can be called in IRQ context
5483  * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
5484  *
5485  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_skb() and
5486  * ieee80211_tx_status_ni() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5487  *
5488  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5489  * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5490  */
5491 void ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5492 				 struct sk_buff *skb);
5493 
5494 /**
5495  * ieee80211_report_low_ack - report non-responding station
5496  *
5497  * When operating in AP-mode, call this function to report a non-responding
5498  * connected STA.
5499  *
5500  * @sta: the non-responding connected sta
5501  * @num_packets: number of packets sent to @sta without a response
5502  */
5503 void ieee80211_report_low_ack(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u32 num_packets);
5504 
5505 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM 2
5506 
5507 /**
5508  * struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets - mutable beacon offsets
5509  * @tim_offset: position of TIM element
5510  * @tim_length: size of TIM element
5511  * @cntdwn_counter_offs: array of IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM offsets
5512  *	to countdown counters.  This array can contain zero values which
5513  *	should be ignored.
5514  * @mbssid_off: position of the multiple bssid element
5515  */
5516 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets {
5517 	u16 tim_offset;
5518 	u16 tim_length;
5519 
5520 	u16 cntdwn_counter_offs[IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM];
5521 	u16 mbssid_off;
5522 };
5523 
5524 /**
5525  * ieee80211_beacon_get_template - beacon template generation function
5526  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5527  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5528  * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5529  *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5530  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5531  *	that is not associated with AP MLD).
5532  *
5533  * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5534  * obtain the beacon template.
5535  *
5536  * This function should be used if the beacon frames are generated by the
5537  * device, and then the driver must use the returned beacon as the template
5538  * The driver or the device are responsible to update the DTIM and, when
5539  * applicable, the CSA count.
5540  *
5541  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5542  *
5543  * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5544  */
5545 struct sk_buff *
5546 ieee80211_beacon_get_template(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5547 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5548 			      struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
5549 			      unsigned int link_id);
5550 
5551 /**
5552  * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index - EMA beacon template generation
5553  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5554  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5555  * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5556  *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5557  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP).
5558  * @ema_index: index of the beacon in the EMA set.
5559  *
5560  * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template()
5561  * but returns a beacon template which includes multiple BSSID element at the
5562  * requested index.
5563  *
5564  * Return: The beacon template. %NULL indicates the end of EMA templates.
5565  */
5566 struct sk_buff *
5567 ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5568 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5569 					struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
5570 					unsigned int link_id, u8 ema_index);
5571 
5572 /**
5573  * struct ieee80211_ema_beacons - List of EMA beacons
5574  * @cnt: count of EMA beacons.
5575  *
5576  * @bcn: array of EMA beacons.
5577  * @bcn.skb: the skb containing this specific beacon
5578  * @bcn.offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5579  *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5580  */
5581 struct ieee80211_ema_beacons {
5582 	u8 cnt;
5583 	struct {
5584 		struct sk_buff *skb;
5585 		struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets offs;
5586 	} bcn[];
5587 };
5588 
5589 /**
5590  * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list - EMA beacon template generation
5591  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5592  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5593  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP)
5594  *
5595  * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template()
5596  * but allocates and returns a pointer to list of all beacon templates required
5597  * to cover all profiles in the multiple BSSID set. Each template includes only
5598  * one multiple BSSID element.
5599  *
5600  * Driver must call ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list() to free the memory.
5601  *
5602  * Return: EMA beacon templates of type struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *.
5603  *	%NULL on error.
5604  */
5605 struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *
5606 ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5607 				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5608 				       unsigned int link_id);
5609 
5610 /**
5611  * ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list - free an EMA beacon template list
5612  * @ema_beacons: list of EMA beacons of type &struct ieee80211_ema_beacons pointers.
5613  *
5614  * This function will free a list previously acquired by calling
5615  * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list()
5616  */
5617 void ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list(struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *ema_beacons);
5618 
5619 /**
5620  * ieee80211_beacon_get_tim - beacon generation function
5621  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5622  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5623  * @tim_offset: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE offset.
5624  *	Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5625  * @tim_length: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE length,
5626  *	(including the ID and length bytes!).
5627  *	Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5628  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5629  *	that is not associated with AP MLD).
5630  *
5631  * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5632  * obtain the beacon frame.
5633  *
5634  * If the beacon frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5635  * hardware/firmware), the driver uses this function to get each beacon
5636  * frame from mac80211 -- it is responsible for calling this function exactly
5637  * once before the beacon is needed (e.g. based on hardware interrupt).
5638  *
5639  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5640  *
5641  * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5642  */
5643 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5644 					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5645 					 u16 *tim_offset, u16 *tim_length,
5646 					 unsigned int link_id);
5647 
5648 /**
5649  * ieee80211_beacon_get - beacon generation function
5650  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5651  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5652  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5653  *	that is not associated with AP MLD).
5654  *
5655  * See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5656  *
5657  * Return: See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5658  */
ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_vif * vif,unsigned int link_id)5659 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5660 						   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5661 						   unsigned int link_id)
5662 {
5663 	return ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(hw, vif, NULL, NULL, link_id);
5664 }
5665 
5666 /**
5667  * ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn - request mac80211 to decrement the beacon countdown
5668  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5669  * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5670  *
5671  * The beacon counter should be updated after each beacon transmission.
5672  * This function is called implicitly when
5673  * ieee80211_beacon_get/ieee80211_beacon_get_tim are called, however if the
5674  * beacon frames are generated by the device, the driver should call this
5675  * function after each beacon transmission to sync mac80211's beacon countdown.
5676  *
5677  * Return: new countdown value
5678  */
5679 u8 ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5680 				  unsigned int link_id);
5681 
5682 /**
5683  * ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn - request mac80211 to set beacon countdown
5684  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5685  * @counter: the new value for the counter
5686  *
5687  * The beacon countdown can be changed by the device, this API should be
5688  * used by the device driver to update csa counter in mac80211.
5689  *
5690  * It should never be used together with ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(),
5691  * as it will cause a race condition around the counter value.
5692  */
5693 void ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 counter);
5694 
5695 /**
5696  * ieee80211_csa_finish - notify mac80211 about channel switch
5697  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5698  * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5699  *
5700  * After a channel switch announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5701  * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5702  * notify mac80211 that the channel can be changed.
5703  */
5704 void ieee80211_csa_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id);
5705 
5706 /**
5707  * ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete - find out if countdown reached 1
5708  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5709  * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5710  *
5711  * Return: %true if the countdown reached 1, %false otherwise
5712  */
5713 bool ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5714 					 unsigned int link_id);
5715 
5716 /**
5717  * ieee80211_color_change_finish - notify mac80211 about color change
5718  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5719  * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5720  *
5721  * After a color change announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5722  * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5723  * notify mac80211 that the color can be changed
5724  */
5725 void ieee80211_color_change_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 link_id);
5726 
5727 /**
5728  * ieee80211_proberesp_get - retrieve a Probe Response template
5729  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5730  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5731  *
5732  * Creates a Probe Response template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5733  * hardware. The destination address should be set by the caller.
5734  *
5735  * Can only be called in AP mode.
5736  *
5737  * Return: The Probe Response template. %NULL on error.
5738  */
5739 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_proberesp_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5740 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5741 
5742 /**
5743  * ieee80211_pspoll_get - retrieve a PS Poll template
5744  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5745  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5746  *
5747  * Creates a PS Poll a template which can, for example, uploaded to
5748  * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5749  * AID, BSSID and MAC address is used.
5750  *
5751  * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5752  * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit.
5753  *
5754  * Return: The PS Poll template. %NULL on error.
5755  */
5756 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_pspoll_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5757 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5758 
5759 /**
5760  * ieee80211_nullfunc_get - retrieve a nullfunc template
5761  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5762  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5763  * @link_id: If the vif is an MLD, get a frame with the link addresses
5764  *	for the given link ID. For a link_id < 0 you get a frame with
5765  *	MLD addresses, however useful that might be.
5766  * @qos_ok: QoS NDP is acceptable to the caller, this should be set
5767  *	if at all possible
5768  *
5769  * Creates a Nullfunc template which can, for example, uploaded to
5770  * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5771  * BSSID and address is used.
5772  *
5773  * If @qos_ndp is set and the association is to an AP with QoS/WMM, the
5774  * returned packet will be QoS NDP.
5775  *
5776  * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5777  * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit as well as Duration and Sequence Control fields.
5778  *
5779  * Return: The nullfunc template. %NULL on error.
5780  */
5781 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_nullfunc_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5782 				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5783 				       int link_id, bool qos_ok);
5784 
5785 /**
5786  * ieee80211_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
5787  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5788  * @src_addr: source MAC address
5789  * @ssid: SSID buffer
5790  * @ssid_len: length of SSID
5791  * @tailroom: tailroom to reserve at end of SKB for IEs
5792  *
5793  * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5794  * hardware.
5795  *
5796  * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
5797  */
5798 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5799 				       const u8 *src_addr,
5800 				       const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
5801 				       size_t tailroom);
5802 
5803 /**
5804  * ieee80211_rts_get - RTS frame generation function
5805  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5806  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5807  * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5808  * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5809  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5810  * @rts: The buffer where to store the RTS frame.
5811  *
5812  * If the RTS frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5813  * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5814  * the next RTS frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5815  * for calling this function before and RTS frame is needed.
5816  */
5817 void ieee80211_rts_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5818 		       const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5819 		       const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5820 		       struct ieee80211_rts *rts);
5821 
5822 /**
5823  * ieee80211_rts_duration - Get the duration field for an RTS frame
5824  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5825  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5826  * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5827  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5828  *
5829  * If the RTS is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5830  * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5831  * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5832  *
5833  * Return: The duration.
5834  */
5835 __le16 ieee80211_rts_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5836 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif, size_t frame_len,
5837 			      const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5838 
5839 /**
5840  * ieee80211_ctstoself_get - CTS-to-self frame generation function
5841  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5842  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5843  * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5844  * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5845  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5846  * @cts: The buffer where to store the CTS-to-self frame.
5847  *
5848  * If the CTS-to-self frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5849  * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5850  * the next CTS-to-self frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5851  * for calling this function before and CTS-to-self frame is needed.
5852  */
5853 void ieee80211_ctstoself_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5854 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5855 			     const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5856 			     const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5857 			     struct ieee80211_cts *cts);
5858 
5859 /**
5860  * ieee80211_ctstoself_duration - Get the duration field for a CTS-to-self frame
5861  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5862  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5863  * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5864  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5865  *
5866  * If the CTS-to-self is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5867  * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5868  * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5869  *
5870  * Return: The duration.
5871  */
5872 __le16 ieee80211_ctstoself_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5873 				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5874 				    size_t frame_len,
5875 				    const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5876 
5877 /**
5878  * ieee80211_generic_frame_duration - Calculate the duration field for a frame
5879  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5880  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5881  * @band: the band to calculate the frame duration on
5882  * @frame_len: the length of the frame.
5883  * @rate: the rate at which the frame is going to be transmitted.
5884  *
5885  * Calculate the duration field of some generic frame, given its
5886  * length and transmission rate (in 100kbps).
5887  *
5888  * Return: The duration.
5889  */
5890 __le16 ieee80211_generic_frame_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5891 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5892 					enum nl80211_band band,
5893 					size_t frame_len,
5894 					struct ieee80211_rate *rate);
5895 
5896 /**
5897  * ieee80211_get_buffered_bc - accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames
5898  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5899  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5900  *
5901  * Function for accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames. If
5902  * hardware/firmware does not implement buffering of broadcast/multicast
5903  * frames when power saving is used, 802.11 code buffers them in the host
5904  * memory. The low-level driver uses this function to fetch next buffered
5905  * frame. In most cases, this is used when generating beacon frame.
5906  *
5907  * Return: A pointer to the next buffered skb or NULL if no more buffered
5908  * frames are available.
5909  *
5910  * Note: buffered frames are returned only after DTIM beacon frame was
5911  * generated with ieee80211_beacon_get() and the low-level driver must thus
5912  * call ieee80211_beacon_get() first. ieee80211_get_buffered_bc() returns
5913  * NULL if the previous generated beacon was not DTIM, so the low-level driver
5914  * does not need to check for DTIM beacons separately and should be able to
5915  * use common code for all beacons.
5916  */
5917 struct sk_buff *
5918 ieee80211_get_buffered_bc(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5919 
5920 /**
5921  * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv - get a TKIP phase 1 key for IV32
5922  *
5923  * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32.
5924  *
5925  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5926  * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5927  * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5928  */
5929 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5930 			       u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5931 
5932 /**
5933  * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key
5934  *
5935  * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the IV32 taken
5936  * from the given packet.
5937  *
5938  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5939  * @skb: the packet to take the IV32 value from that will be encrypted
5940  *	with this P1K
5941  * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5942  */
ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf * keyconf,struct sk_buff * skb,u16 * p1k)5943 static inline void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5944 					  struct sk_buff *skb, u16 *p1k)
5945 {
5946 	struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (struct ieee80211_hdr *)skb->data;
5947 	const u8 *data = (u8 *)hdr + ieee80211_hdrlen(hdr->frame_control);
5948 	u32 iv32 = get_unaligned_le32(&data[4]);
5949 
5950 	ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(keyconf, iv32, p1k);
5951 }
5952 
5953 /**
5954  * ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key for RX
5955  *
5956  * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32
5957  * and transmitter address.
5958  *
5959  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5960  * @ta: TA that will be used with the key
5961  * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5962  * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5963  */
5964 void ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5965 			       const u8 *ta, u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5966 
5967 /**
5968  * ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k - get a TKIP phase 2 key
5969  *
5970  * This function computes the TKIP RC4 key for the IV values
5971  * in the packet.
5972  *
5973  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5974  * @skb: the packet to take the IV32/IV16 values from that will be
5975  *	encrypted with this key
5976  * @p2k: a buffer to which the key will be written, 16 bytes
5977  */
5978 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5979 			    struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *p2k);
5980 
5981 /**
5982  * ieee80211_tkip_add_iv - write TKIP IV and Ext. IV to pos
5983  *
5984  * @pos: start of crypto header
5985  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5986  * @pn: PN to add
5987  *
5988  * Returns: pointer to the octet following IVs (i.e. beginning of
5989  * the packet payload)
5990  *
5991  * This function writes the tkip IV value to pos (which should
5992  * point to the crypto header)
5993  */
5994 u8 *ieee80211_tkip_add_iv(u8 *pos, struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, u64 pn);
5995 
5996 /**
5997  * ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq - get key RX sequence counter
5998  *
5999  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
6000  * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
6001  *	the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
6002  *	CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
6003  * @seq: buffer to receive the sequence data
6004  *
6005  * This function allows a driver to retrieve the current RX IV/PNs
6006  * for the given key. It must not be called if IV checking is done
6007  * by the device and not by mac80211.
6008  *
6009  * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
6010  * can be done concurrently.
6011  */
6012 void ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
6013 			      int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
6014 
6015 /**
6016  * ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq - set key RX sequence counter
6017  *
6018  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
6019  * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
6020  *	the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
6021  *	CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
6022  * @seq: new sequence data
6023  *
6024  * This function allows a driver to set the current RX IV/PNs for the
6025  * given key. This is useful when resuming from WoWLAN sleep and GTK
6026  * rekey may have been done while suspended. It should not be called
6027  * if IV checking is done by the device and not by mac80211.
6028  *
6029  * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
6030  * can be done concurrently.
6031  */
6032 void ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
6033 			      int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
6034 
6035 /**
6036  * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add - add a GTK key from rekeying during WoWLAN
6037  * @vif: the virtual interface to add the key on
6038  * @idx: the keyidx of the key
6039  * @key_data: the key data
6040  * @key_len: the key data. Might be bigger than the actual key length,
6041  *	but not smaller (for the driver convinence)
6042  * @link_id: the link id of the key or -1 for non-MLO
6043  *
6044  * When GTK rekeying was done while the system was suspended, (a) new
6045  * key(s) will be available. These will be needed by mac80211 for proper
6046  * RX processing, so this function allows setting them.
6047  *
6048  * Return: the newly allocated key structure, which will have
6049  * similar contents to the passed key configuration but point to
6050  * mac80211-owned memory. In case of errors, the function returns an
6051  * ERR_PTR(), use IS_ERR() etc.
6052  *
6053  * Note that this function assumes the key isn't added to hardware
6054  * acceleration, so no TX will be done with the key. Since it's a GTK
6055  * on managed (station) networks, this is true anyway. If the driver
6056  * calls this function from the resume callback and subsequently uses
6057  * the return code 1 to reconfigure the device, this key will be part
6058  * of the reconfiguration.
6059  *
6060  * Note that the driver should also call ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq()
6061  * for the new key for each TID to set up sequence counters properly.
6062  *
6063  * IMPORTANT: If this replaces a key that is present in the hardware,
6064  * then it will attempt to remove it during this call.
6065  */
6066 struct ieee80211_key_conf *
6067 ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6068 			u8 idx, u8 *key_data, u8 key_len,
6069 			int link_id);
6070 
6071 /**
6072  * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace supplicant of rekeying
6073  * @vif: virtual interface the rekeying was done on
6074  * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP, for checking association
6075  * @replay_ctr: the new replay counter after GTK rekeying
6076  * @gfp: allocation flags
6077  */
6078 void ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *bssid,
6079 				const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
6080 
6081 /**
6082  * ieee80211_key_mic_failure - increment MIC failure counter for the key
6083  *
6084  * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
6085  * at the same time.
6086  *
6087  * @keyconf: the key in question
6088  */
6089 void ieee80211_key_mic_failure(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
6090 
6091 /**
6092  * ieee80211_key_replay - increment replay counter for the key
6093  *
6094  * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
6095  * at the same time.
6096  *
6097  * @keyconf: the key in question
6098  */
6099 void ieee80211_key_replay(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
6100 
6101 /**
6102  * ieee80211_wake_queue - wake specific queue
6103  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6104  * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
6105  *
6106  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_wake_queue.
6107  */
6108 void ieee80211_wake_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
6109 
6110 /**
6111  * ieee80211_stop_queue - stop specific queue
6112  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6113  * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
6114  *
6115  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
6116  */
6117 void ieee80211_stop_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
6118 
6119 /**
6120  * ieee80211_queue_stopped - test status of the queue
6121  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6122  * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
6123  *
6124  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_queue_stopped.
6125  *
6126  * Return: %true if the queue is stopped. %false otherwise.
6127  */
6128 
6129 int ieee80211_queue_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
6130 
6131 /**
6132  * ieee80211_stop_queues - stop all queues
6133  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6134  *
6135  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_stop_all_queues.
6136  */
6137 void ieee80211_stop_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6138 
6139 /**
6140  * ieee80211_wake_queues - wake all queues
6141  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6142  *
6143  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_wake_all_queues.
6144  */
6145 void ieee80211_wake_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6146 
6147 /**
6148  * ieee80211_scan_completed - completed hardware scan
6149  *
6150  * When hardware scan offload is used (i.e. the hw_scan() callback is
6151  * assigned) this function needs to be called by the driver to notify
6152  * mac80211 that the scan finished. This function can be called from
6153  * any context, including hardirq context.
6154  *
6155  * @hw: the hardware that finished the scan
6156  * @info: information about the completed scan
6157  */
6158 void ieee80211_scan_completed(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6159 			      struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
6160 
6161 /**
6162  * ieee80211_sched_scan_results - got results from scheduled scan
6163  *
6164  * When a scheduled scan is running, this function needs to be called by the
6165  * driver whenever there are new scan results available.
6166  *
6167  * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
6168  */
6169 void ieee80211_sched_scan_results(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6170 
6171 /**
6172  * ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped - inform that the scheduled scan has stopped
6173  *
6174  * When a scheduled scan is running, this function can be called by
6175  * the driver if it needs to stop the scan to perform another task.
6176  * Usual scenarios are drivers that cannot continue the scheduled scan
6177  * while associating, for instance.
6178  *
6179  * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
6180  */
6181 void ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6182 
6183 /**
6184  * enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags - interface iteration flags
6185  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL: Iterate over all interfaces that have
6186  *	been added to the driver; However, note that during hardware
6187  *	reconfiguration (after restart_hw) it will iterate over a new
6188  *	interface and over all the existing interfaces even if they
6189  *	haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
6190  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL: During resume, iterate over all
6191  *	interfaces, even if they haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
6192  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE: Iterate only active interfaces (netdev is up).
6193  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER: Skip any interfaces where SDATA
6194  *	is not in the driver.  This may fix crashes during firmware recovery
6195  *	for instance.
6196  */
6197 enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags {
6198 	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL	= 0,
6199 	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL	= BIT(0),
6200 	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE	= BIT(1),
6201 	IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER	= BIT(2),
6202 };
6203 
6204 /**
6205  * ieee80211_iterate_interfaces - iterate interfaces
6206  *
6207  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6208  * hardware and calls the callback for them. This includes active as well as
6209  * inactive interfaces. This function allows the iterator function to sleep.
6210  * Will iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6211  *
6212  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6213  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6214  * @iterator: the iterator function to call
6215  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6216  */
6217 void ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
6218 				  void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
6219 						   struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6220 				  void *data);
6221 
6222 /**
6223  * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces - iterate active interfaces
6224  *
6225  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6226  * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6227  * This function allows the iterator function to sleep, when the iterator
6228  * function is atomic @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic can
6229  * be used.
6230  * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6231  *
6232  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6233  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6234  * @iterator: the iterator function to call
6235  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6236  */
6237 static inline void
ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,u32 iter_flags,void (* iterator)(void * data,u8 * mac,struct ieee80211_vif * vif),void * data)6238 ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
6239 				    void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
6240 						     struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6241 				    void *data)
6242 {
6243 	ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(hw,
6244 				     iter_flags | IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE,
6245 				     iterator, data);
6246 }
6247 
6248 /**
6249  * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic - iterate active interfaces
6250  *
6251  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6252  * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6253  * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
6254  * if that is not desired, use @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces instead.
6255  * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6256  *
6257  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6258  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6259  * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6260  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6261  */
6262 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6263 						u32 iter_flags,
6264 						void (*iterator)(void *data,
6265 						    u8 *mac,
6266 						    struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6267 						void *data);
6268 
6269 /**
6270  * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx - iterate active interfaces
6271  *
6272  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6273  * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6274  * This version can only be used while holding the wiphy mutex.
6275  *
6276  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6277  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6278  * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6279  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6280  */
6281 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6282 					     u32 iter_flags,
6283 					     void (*iterator)(void *data,
6284 						u8 *mac,
6285 						struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6286 					     void *data);
6287 
6288 /**
6289  * ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic - iterate stations
6290  *
6291  * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
6292  * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
6293  * function for them.
6294  * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
6295  *
6296  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6297  * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6298  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6299  */
6300 void ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6301 				       void (*iterator)(void *data,
6302 						struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
6303 				       void *data);
6304 
6305 /**
6306  * ieee80211_iterate_stations_mtx - iterate stations
6307  *
6308  * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
6309  * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
6310  * function for them. This version can only be used while holding the wiphy
6311  * mutex.
6312  *
6313  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6314  * @iterator: the iterator function to call
6315  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6316  */
6317 void ieee80211_iterate_stations_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6318 				    void (*iterator)(void *data,
6319 						     struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
6320 				    void *data);
6321 
6322 /**
6323  * ieee80211_queue_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
6324  *
6325  * Drivers and mac80211 use this to add work onto the mac80211 workqueue.
6326  * This helper ensures drivers are not queueing work when they should not be.
6327  *
6328  * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
6329  * @work: the work we want to add onto the mac80211 workqueue
6330  */
6331 void ieee80211_queue_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct work_struct *work);
6332 
6333 /**
6334  * ieee80211_queue_delayed_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
6335  *
6336  * Drivers and mac80211 use this to queue delayed work onto the mac80211
6337  * workqueue.
6338  *
6339  * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
6340  * @dwork: delayable work to queue onto the mac80211 workqueue
6341  * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing
6342  */
6343 void ieee80211_queue_delayed_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6344 				  struct delayed_work *dwork,
6345 				  unsigned long delay);
6346 
6347 /**
6348  * ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer - Refresh a tx agg session timer.
6349  * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
6350  * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6351  *
6352  * This function allows low level driver to refresh tx agg session timer
6353  * to maintain BA session, the session level will still be managed by the
6354  * mac80211.
6355  *
6356  * Note: must be called in an RCU critical section.
6357  */
6358 void ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6359 					    u16 tid);
6360 
6361 /**
6362  * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session - Start a tx Block Ack session.
6363  * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
6364  * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6365  * @timeout: session timeout value (in TUs)
6366  *
6367  * Return: success if addBA request was sent, failure otherwise
6368  *
6369  * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
6370  * the need to start aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
6371  * will be managed by the mac80211.
6372  */
6373 int ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid,
6374 				  u16 timeout);
6375 
6376 /**
6377  * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to aggregate.
6378  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6379  * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6380  * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6381  *
6382  * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6383  * finished with preparations for the BA session. It can be called
6384  * from any context.
6385  */
6386 void ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6387 				      u16 tid);
6388 
6389 /**
6390  * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session - Stop a Block Ack session.
6391  * @sta: the station whose BA session to stop
6392  * @tid: the TID to stop BA.
6393  *
6394  * Return: negative error if the TID is invalid, or no aggregation active
6395  *
6396  * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
6397  * the need to stop aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
6398  * will be managed by the mac80211.
6399  */
6400 int ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid);
6401 
6402 /**
6403  * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to stop aggregate.
6404  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6405  * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6406  * @tid: the desired TID to BA on.
6407  *
6408  * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6409  * finished with preparations for the BA session tear down. It
6410  * can be called from any context.
6411  */
6412 void ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6413 				     u16 tid);
6414 
6415 /**
6416  * ieee80211_find_sta - find a station
6417  *
6418  * @vif: virtual interface to look for station on
6419  * @addr: station's address
6420  *
6421  * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6422  *
6423  * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6424  * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6425  */
6426 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6427 					 const u8 *addr);
6428 
6429 /**
6430  * ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr - find a station on hardware
6431  *
6432  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6433  * @addr: remote station's address
6434  * @localaddr: local address (vif->sdata->vif.addr). Use NULL for 'any'.
6435  *
6436  * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6437  *
6438  * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6439  * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6440  *
6441  * NOTE: You may pass NULL for localaddr, but then you will just get
6442  *      the first STA that matches the remote address 'addr'.
6443  *      We can have multiple STA associated with multiple
6444  *      logical stations (e.g. consider a station connecting to another
6445  *      BSSID on the same AP hardware without disconnecting first).
6446  *      In this case, the result of this method with localaddr NULL
6447  *      is not reliable.
6448  *
6449  * DO NOT USE THIS FUNCTION with localaddr NULL if at all possible.
6450  */
6451 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6452 					       const u8 *addr,
6453 					       const u8 *localaddr);
6454 
6455 /**
6456  * ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs - find STA by link addresses
6457  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6458  * @addr: remote station's link address
6459  * @localaddr: local link address, use %NULL for any (but avoid that)
6460  * @link_id: pointer to obtain the link ID if the STA is found,
6461  *	may be %NULL if the link ID is not needed
6462  *
6463  * Obtain the STA by link address, must use RCU protection.
6464  *
6465  * Return: pointer to STA if found, otherwise %NULL.
6466  */
6467 struct ieee80211_sta *
6468 ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6469 				 const u8 *addr,
6470 				 const u8 *localaddr,
6471 				 unsigned int *link_id);
6472 
6473 /**
6474  * ieee80211_sta_block_awake - block station from waking up
6475  * @hw: the hardware
6476  * @pubsta: the station
6477  * @block: whether to block or unblock
6478  *
6479  * Some devices require that all frames that are on the queues
6480  * for a specific station that went to sleep are flushed before
6481  * a poll response or frames after the station woke up can be
6482  * delivered to that it. Note that such frames must be rejected
6483  * by the driver as filtered, with the appropriate status flag.
6484  *
6485  * This function allows implementing this mode in a race-free
6486  * manner.
6487  *
6488  * To do this, a driver must keep track of the number of frames
6489  * still enqueued for a specific station. If this number is not
6490  * zero when the station goes to sleep, the driver must call
6491  * this function to force mac80211 to consider the station to
6492  * be asleep regardless of the station's actual state. Once the
6493  * number of outstanding frames reaches zero, the driver must
6494  * call this function again to unblock the station. That will
6495  * cause mac80211 to be able to send ps-poll responses, and if
6496  * the station queried in the meantime then frames will also
6497  * be sent out as a result of this. Additionally, the driver
6498  * will be notified that the station woke up some time after
6499  * it is unblocked, regardless of whether the station actually
6500  * woke up while blocked or not.
6501  */
6502 void ieee80211_sta_block_awake(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6503 			       struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, bool block);
6504 
6505 /**
6506  * ieee80211_sta_eosp - notify mac80211 about end of SP
6507  * @pubsta: the station
6508  *
6509  * When a device transmits frames in a way that it can't tell
6510  * mac80211 in the TX status about the EOSP, it must clear the
6511  * %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP bit and call this function instead.
6512  * This applies for PS-Poll as well as uAPSD.
6513  *
6514  * Note that just like with _tx_status() and _rx() drivers must
6515  * not mix calls to irqsafe/non-irqsafe versions, this function
6516  * must not be mixed with those either. Use the all irqsafe, or
6517  * all non-irqsafe, don't mix!
6518  *
6519  * NB: the _irqsafe version of this function doesn't exist, no
6520  *     driver needs it right now. Don't call this function if
6521  *     you'd need the _irqsafe version, look at the git history
6522  *     and restore the _irqsafe version!
6523  */
6524 void ieee80211_sta_eosp(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6525 
6526 /**
6527  * ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc - ask mac80211 to send NDP with EOSP
6528  * @pubsta: the station
6529  * @tid: the tid of the NDP
6530  *
6531  * Sometimes the device understands that it needs to close
6532  * the Service Period unexpectedly. This can happen when
6533  * sending frames that are filling holes in the BA window.
6534  * In this case, the device can ask mac80211 to send a
6535  * Nullfunc frame with EOSP set. When that happens, the
6536  * driver must have called ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() to
6537  * let mac80211 know that there are no buffered frames any
6538  * more, otherwise mac80211 will get the more_data bit wrong.
6539  * The low level driver must have made sure that the frame
6540  * will be sent despite the station being in power-save.
6541  * Mac80211 won't call allow_buffered_frames().
6542  * Note that calling this function, doesn't exempt the driver
6543  * from closing the EOSP properly, it will still have to call
6544  * ieee80211_sta_eosp when the NDP is sent.
6545  */
6546 void ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, int tid);
6547 
6548 /**
6549  * ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates - recalculate aggregate data after a change
6550  * @pubsta: the station
6551  *
6552  * Call this function after changing a per-link aggregate data as referenced in
6553  * &struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates by accessing the agg field of
6554  * &struct ieee80211_link_sta.
6555  *
6556  * With non MLO the data in deflink will be referenced directly. In that case
6557  * there is no need to call this function.
6558  */
6559 void ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6560 
6561 /**
6562  * ieee80211_sta_register_airtime - register airtime usage for a sta/tid
6563  *
6564  * Register airtime usage for a given sta on a given tid. The driver must call
6565  * this function to notify mac80211 that a station used a certain amount of
6566  * airtime. This information will be used by the TXQ scheduler to schedule
6567  * stations in a way that ensures airtime fairness.
6568  *
6569  * The reported airtime should as a minimum include all time that is spent
6570  * transmitting to the remote station, including overhead and padding, but not
6571  * including time spent waiting for a TXOP. If the time is not reported by the
6572  * hardware it can in some cases be calculated from the rate and known frame
6573  * composition. When possible, the time should include any failed transmission
6574  * attempts.
6575  *
6576  * The driver can either call this function synchronously for every packet or
6577  * aggregate, or asynchronously as airtime usage information becomes available.
6578  * TX and RX airtime can be reported together, or separately by setting one of
6579  * them to 0.
6580  *
6581  * @pubsta: the station
6582  * @tid: the TID to register airtime for
6583  * @tx_airtime: airtime used during TX (in usec)
6584  * @rx_airtime: airtime used during RX (in usec)
6585  */
6586 void ieee80211_sta_register_airtime(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6587 				    u32 tx_airtime, u32 rx_airtime);
6588 
6589 /**
6590  * ieee80211_txq_airtime_check - check if a txq can send frame to device
6591  *
6592  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6593  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
6594  *
6595  * Return: %true if the AQL's airtime limit has not been reached and the txq can
6596  * continue to send more packets to the device. Otherwise return %false.
6597  */
6598 bool
6599 ieee80211_txq_airtime_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
6600 
6601 /**
6602  * ieee80211_iter_keys - iterate keys programmed into the device
6603  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6604  * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6605  * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6606  * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6607  *
6608  * Context: Must be called with wiphy mutex held; can sleep.
6609  *
6610  * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6611  * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6612  * the device. This is intended for use in WoWLAN if the device
6613  * needs reprogramming of the keys during suspend.
6614  *
6615  * The order in which the keys are iterated matches the order
6616  * in which they were originally installed and handed to the
6617  * set_key callback.
6618  */
6619 void ieee80211_iter_keys(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6620 			 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6621 			 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6622 				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6623 				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6624 				      struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6625 				      void *data),
6626 			 void *iter_data);
6627 
6628 /**
6629  * ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu - iterate keys programmed into the device
6630  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6631  * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6632  * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6633  * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6634  *
6635  * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6636  * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6637  * the device. Note that due to locking reasons, keys of station
6638  * in removal process will be skipped.
6639  *
6640  * This function requires being called in an RCU critical section,
6641  * and thus iter must be atomic.
6642  */
6643 void ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6644 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6645 			     void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6646 					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6647 					  struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6648 					  struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6649 					  void *data),
6650 			     void *iter_data);
6651 
6652 /**
6653  * ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic - iterate channel contexts
6654  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6655  * @iter: iterator function
6656  * @iter_data: data passed to iterator function
6657  *
6658  * Iterate all active channel contexts. This function is atomic and
6659  * doesn't acquire any locks internally that might be held in other
6660  * places while calling into the driver.
6661  *
6662  * The iterator will not find a context that's being added (during
6663  * the driver callback to add it) but will find it while it's being
6664  * removed.
6665  *
6666  * Note that during hardware restart, all contexts that existed
6667  * before the restart are considered already present so will be
6668  * found while iterating, whether they've been re-added already
6669  * or not.
6670  */
6671 void ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic(
6672 	struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6673 	void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6674 		     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf,
6675 		     void *data),
6676 	void *iter_data);
6677 
6678 /**
6679  * ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_mtx - iterate channel contexts
6680  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6681  * @iter: iterator function
6682  * @iter_data: data passed to iterator function
6683  *
6684  * Iterate all active channel contexts. This function can only be used while
6685  * holding the wiphy mutex.
6686  *
6687  * The iterator will not find a context that's being added (during
6688  * the driver callback to add it) but will find it while it's being
6689  * removed.
6690  *
6691  * Note that during hardware restart, all contexts that existed
6692  * before the restart are considered already present so will be
6693  * found while iterating, whether they've been re-added already
6694  * or not.
6695  */
6696 void ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_mtx(
6697 	struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6698 	void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6699 		     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf,
6700 		     void *data),
6701 	void *iter_data);
6702 
6703 /**
6704  * ieee80211_ap_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
6705  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6706  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6707  *
6708  * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
6709  * hardware. The template is filled with bssid, ssid and supported rate
6710  * information. This function must only be called from within the
6711  * .bss_info_changed callback function and only in managed mode. The function
6712  * is only useful when the interface is associated, otherwise it will return
6713  * %NULL.
6714  *
6715  * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
6716  */
6717 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_ap_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6718 					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6719 
6720 /**
6721  * ieee80211_beacon_loss - inform hardware does not receive beacons
6722  *
6723  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6724  *
6725  * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER and
6726  * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set, the driver needs to inform whenever the
6727  * hardware is not receiving beacons with this function.
6728  */
6729 void ieee80211_beacon_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6730 
6731 /**
6732  * ieee80211_connection_loss - inform hardware has lost connection to the AP
6733  *
6734  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6735  *
6736  * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER, and
6737  * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS and %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR are set, the driver
6738  * needs to inform if the connection to the AP has been lost.
6739  * The function may also be called if the connection needs to be terminated
6740  * for some other reason, even if %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR isn't set.
6741  *
6742  * This function will cause immediate change to disassociated state,
6743  * without connection recovery attempts.
6744  */
6745 void ieee80211_connection_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6746 
6747 /**
6748  * ieee80211_disconnect - request disconnection
6749  *
6750  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6751  * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired
6752  *
6753  * Request disconnection from the current network and, if enabled, send a
6754  * hint to the higher layers that immediate reconnect is desired.
6755  */
6756 void ieee80211_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool reconnect);
6757 
6758 /**
6759  * ieee80211_resume_disconnect - disconnect from AP after resume
6760  *
6761  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6762  *
6763  * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after resume.
6764  * Drivers can use this after WoWLAN if they know that the
6765  * connection cannot be kept up, for example because keys were
6766  * used while the device was asleep but the replay counters or
6767  * similar cannot be retrieved from the device during resume.
6768  *
6769  * Note that due to implementation issues, if the driver uses
6770  * the reconfiguration functionality during resume the interface
6771  * will still be added as associated first during resume and then
6772  * disconnect normally later.
6773  *
6774  * This function can only be called from the resume callback and
6775  * the driver must not be holding any of its own locks while it
6776  * calls this function, or at least not any locks it needs in the
6777  * key configuration paths (if it supports HW crypto).
6778  */
6779 void ieee80211_resume_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6780 
6781 /**
6782  * ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect - disconnect from AP after
6783  * hardware restart
6784  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6785  *
6786  * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after
6787  * hardware restart.
6788  */
6789 void ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6790 
6791 /**
6792  * ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify - inform a configured connection quality monitoring
6793  *	rssi threshold triggered
6794  *
6795  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6796  * @rssi_event: the RSSI trigger event type
6797  * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
6798  * @gfp: context flags
6799  *
6800  * When the %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI is set, and a connection quality
6801  * monitoring is configured with an rssi threshold, the driver will inform
6802  * whenever the rssi level reaches the threshold.
6803  */
6804 void ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6805 			       enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
6806 			       s32 rssi_level,
6807 			       gfp_t gfp);
6808 
6809 /**
6810  * ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - inform CQM of beacon loss
6811  *
6812  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6813  * @gfp: context flags
6814  */
6815 void ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, gfp_t gfp);
6816 
6817 /**
6818  * ieee80211_radar_detected - inform that a radar was detected
6819  *
6820  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6821  * @chanctx_conf: Channel context on which radar is detected. Mandatory to
6822  *	pass a valid pointer during MLO. For non-MLO %NULL can be passed
6823  */
6824 void ieee80211_radar_detected(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6825 			      struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf);
6826 
6827 /**
6828  * ieee80211_chswitch_done - Complete channel switch process
6829  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6830  * @success: make the channel switch successful or not
6831  * @link_id: the link_id on which the switch was done. Ignored if success is
6832  *	false.
6833  *
6834  * Complete the channel switch post-process: set the new operational channel
6835  * and wake up the suspended queues.
6836  */
6837 void ieee80211_chswitch_done(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool success,
6838 			     unsigned int link_id);
6839 
6840 /**
6841  * ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect - disconnect due to channel switch error
6842  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6843  *
6844  * Instruct mac80211 to disconnect due to a channel switch error. The channel
6845  * switch can request to block the tx and so, we need to make sure we do not send
6846  * a deauth frame in this case.
6847  */
6848 void ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6849 
6850 /**
6851  * ieee80211_request_smps - request SM PS transition
6852  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6853  * @link_id: link ID for MLO, or 0
6854  * @smps_mode: new SM PS mode
6855  *
6856  * This allows the driver to request an SM PS transition in managed
6857  * mode. This is useful when the driver has more information than
6858  * the stack about possible interference, for example by bluetooth.
6859  */
6860 void ieee80211_request_smps(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
6861 			    enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode);
6862 
6863 /**
6864  * ieee80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain-on-channel start
6865  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6866  */
6867 void ieee80211_ready_on_channel(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6868 
6869 /**
6870  * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
6871  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6872  */
6873 void ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6874 
6875 /**
6876  * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session - callback to stop existing BA sessions
6877  *
6878  * in order not to harm the system performance and user experience, the device
6879  * may request not to allow any rx ba session and tear down existing rx ba
6880  * sessions based on system constraints such as periodic BT activity that needs
6881  * to limit wlan activity (eg.sco or a2dp)."
6882  * in such cases, the intention is to limit the duration of the rx ppdu and
6883  * therefore prevent the peer device to use a-mpdu aggregation.
6884  *
6885  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6886  * @ba_rx_bitmap: Bit map of open rx ba per tid
6887  * @addr: & to bssid mac address
6888  */
6889 void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 ba_rx_bitmap,
6890 				  const u8 *addr);
6891 
6892 /**
6893  * ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames - move RX BA window and mark filtered
6894  * @pubsta: station struct
6895  * @tid: the session's TID
6896  * @ssn: starting sequence number of the bitmap, all frames before this are
6897  *	assumed to be out of the window after the call
6898  * @filtered: bitmap of filtered frames, BIT(0) is the @ssn entry etc.
6899  * @received_mpdus: number of received mpdus in firmware
6900  *
6901  * This function moves the BA window and releases all frames before @ssn, and
6902  * marks frames marked in the bitmap as having been filtered. Afterwards, it
6903  * checks if any frames in the window starting from @ssn can now be released
6904  * (in case they were only waiting for frames that were filtered.)
6905  * (Only work correctly if @max_rx_aggregation_subframes <= 64 frames)
6906  */
6907 void ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6908 					  u16 ssn, u64 filtered,
6909 					  u16 received_mpdus);
6910 
6911 /**
6912  * ieee80211_send_bar - send a BlockAckReq frame
6913  *
6914  * can be used to flush pending frames from the peer's aggregation reorder
6915  * buffer.
6916  *
6917  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6918  * @ra: the peer's destination address
6919  * @tid: the TID of the aggregation session
6920  * @ssn: the new starting sequence number for the receiver
6921  */
6922 void ieee80211_send_bar(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 *ra, u16 tid, u16 ssn);
6923 
6924 /**
6925  * ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl - helper to queue an RX BA work
6926  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6927  * @addr: station mac address
6928  * @tid: the rx tid
6929  */
6930 void ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *addr,
6931 				 unsigned int tid);
6932 
6933 /**
6934  * ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl - start a Rx BA session
6935  *
6936  * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6937  * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6938  * reordering.
6939  *
6940  * Create structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6941  * when they complete AddBa negotiation.
6942  *
6943  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6944  * @addr: station mac address
6945  * @tid: the rx tid
6946  */
ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif * vif,const u8 * addr,u16 tid)6947 static inline void ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6948 						      const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6949 {
6950 	if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6951 		return;
6952 	ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid);
6953 }
6954 
6955 /**
6956  * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl - stop a Rx BA session
6957  *
6958  * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6959  * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6960  * reordering.
6961  *
6962  * Destroy structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6963  * when they complete DelBa negotiation.
6964  *
6965  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6966  * @addr: station mac address
6967  * @tid: the rx tid
6968  */
ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif * vif,const u8 * addr,u16 tid)6969 static inline void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6970 						     const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6971 {
6972 	if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6973 		return;
6974 	ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid + IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS);
6975 }
6976 
6977 /**
6978  * ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired - stop a Rx BA session due to timeout
6979  *
6980  * Some device drivers do not offload AddBa/DelBa negotiation, but handle rx
6981  * buffer reording internally, and therefore also handle the session timer.
6982  *
6983  * Trigger the timeout flow, which sends a DelBa.
6984  *
6985  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6986  * @addr: station mac address
6987  * @tid: the rx tid
6988  */
6989 void ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6990 				   const u8 *addr, unsigned int tid);
6991 
6992 /* Rate control API */
6993 
6994 /**
6995  * struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control - rate control information for/from RC algo
6996  *
6997  * @hw: The hardware the algorithm is invoked for.
6998  * @sband: The band this frame is being transmitted on.
6999  * @bss_conf: the current BSS configuration
7000  * @skb: the skb that will be transmitted, the control information in it needs
7001  *	to be filled in
7002  * @reported_rate: The rate control algorithm can fill this in to indicate
7003  *	which rate should be reported to userspace as the current rate and
7004  *	used for rate calculations in the mesh network.
7005  * @rts: whether RTS will be used for this frame because it is longer than the
7006  *	RTS threshold
7007  * @short_preamble: whether mac80211 will request short-preamble transmission
7008  *	if the selected rate supports it
7009  * @rate_idx_mask: user-requested (legacy) rate mask
7010  * @rate_idx_mcs_mask: user-requested MCS rate mask (NULL if not in use)
7011  * @bss: whether this frame is sent out in AP or IBSS mode
7012  */
7013 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control {
7014 	struct ieee80211_hw *hw;
7015 	struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband;
7016 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf *bss_conf;
7017 	struct sk_buff *skb;
7018 	struct ieee80211_tx_rate reported_rate;
7019 	bool rts, short_preamble;
7020 	u32 rate_idx_mask;
7021 	u8 *rate_idx_mcs_mask;
7022 	bool bss;
7023 };
7024 
7025 /**
7026  * enum rate_control_capabilities - rate control capabilities
7027  */
7028 enum rate_control_capabilities {
7029 	/**
7030 	 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW:
7031 	 * Support for extended NSS BW support (dot11VHTExtendedNSSCapable)
7032 	 * Note that this is only looked at if the minimum number of chains
7033 	 * that the AP uses is < the number of TX chains the hardware has,
7034 	 * otherwise the NSS difference doesn't bother us.
7035 	 */
7036 	RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW = BIT(0),
7037 	/**
7038 	 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER:
7039 	 * mac80211 should start A-MPDU sessions on tx
7040 	 */
7041 	RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER = BIT(1),
7042 };
7043 
7044 struct rate_control_ops {
7045 	unsigned long capa;
7046 	const char *name;
7047 	void *(*alloc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
7048 	void (*add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, void *priv,
7049 			    struct dentry *debugfsdir);
7050 	void (*free)(void *priv);
7051 
7052 	void *(*alloc_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, gfp_t gfp);
7053 	void (*rate_init)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7054 			  struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7055 			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta);
7056 	void (*rate_update)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7057 			    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7058 			    struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
7059 			    u32 changed);
7060 	void (*free_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
7061 			 void *priv_sta);
7062 
7063 	void (*tx_status_ext)(void *priv,
7064 			      struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7065 			      void *priv_sta, struct ieee80211_tx_status *st);
7066 	void (*tx_status)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7067 			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
7068 			  struct sk_buff *skb);
7069 	void (*get_rate)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
7070 			 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control *txrc);
7071 
7072 	void (*add_sta_debugfs)(void *priv, void *priv_sta,
7073 				struct dentry *dir);
7074 
7075 	u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(void *priv_sta);
7076 };
7077 
rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta * sta,enum nl80211_band band,int index)7078 static inline int rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
7079 				 enum nl80211_band band,
7080 				 int index)
7081 {
7082 	return (sta == NULL || sta->deflink.supp_rates[band] & BIT(index));
7083 }
7084 
7085 static inline s8
rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_sta * sta)7086 rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7087 		  struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
7088 {
7089 	int i;
7090 
7091 	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
7092 		if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
7093 			return i;
7094 
7095 	/* warn when we cannot find a rate. */
7096 	WARN_ON_ONCE(1);
7097 
7098 	/* and return 0 (the lowest index) */
7099 	return 0;
7100 }
7101 
7102 static inline
rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_sta * sta)7103 bool rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7104 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
7105 {
7106 	unsigned int i;
7107 
7108 	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
7109 		if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
7110 			return true;
7111 	return false;
7112 }
7113 
7114 /**
7115  * rate_control_set_rates - pass the sta rate selection to mac80211/driver
7116  *
7117  * When not doing a rate control probe to test rates, rate control should pass
7118  * its rate selection to mac80211. If the driver supports receiving a station
7119  * rate table, it will use it to ensure that frames are always sent based on
7120  * the most recent rate control module decision.
7121  *
7122  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7123  * @pubsta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer to the target destination.
7124  * @rates: new tx rate set to be used for this station.
7125  *
7126  * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
7127  */
7128 int rate_control_set_rates(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7129 			   struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
7130 			   struct ieee80211_sta_rates *rates);
7131 
7132 int ieee80211_rate_control_register(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
7133 void ieee80211_rate_control_unregister(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
7134 
7135 static inline bool
conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)7136 conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7137 {
7138 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20;
7139 }
7140 
7141 static inline bool
conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)7142 conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7143 {
7144 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
7145 	       conf->chandef.center_freq1 < conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
7146 }
7147 
7148 static inline bool
conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)7149 conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7150 {
7151 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
7152 	       conf->chandef.center_freq1 > conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
7153 }
7154 
7155 static inline bool
conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)7156 conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7157 {
7158 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40;
7159 }
7160 
7161 static inline bool
conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)7162 conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7163 {
7164 	return (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5) &&
7165 		(conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10) &&
7166 		(conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT);
7167 }
7168 
7169 static inline enum nl80211_iftype
ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type,bool p2p)7170 ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type, bool p2p)
7171 {
7172 	if (p2p) {
7173 		switch (type) {
7174 		case NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION:
7175 			return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT;
7176 		case NL80211_IFTYPE_AP:
7177 			return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO;
7178 		default:
7179 			break;
7180 		}
7181 	}
7182 	return type;
7183 }
7184 
7185 static inline enum nl80211_iftype
ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif * vif)7186 ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7187 {
7188 	return ieee80211_iftype_p2p(vif->type, vif->p2p);
7189 }
7190 
7191 /**
7192  * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif - return HE capabilities for sband/vif
7193  * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
7194  * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
7195  *
7196  * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or %NULL is none found
7197  */
7198 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap *
ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_vif * vif)7199 ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7200 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7201 {
7202 	return ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
7203 }
7204 
7205 /**
7206  * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif - return HE 6 GHz capabilities
7207  * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
7208  * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
7209  *
7210  * Return: the 6GHz capabilities
7211  */
7212 static inline __le16
ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_vif * vif)7213 ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7214 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7215 {
7216 	return ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
7217 }
7218 
7219 /**
7220  * ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif - return ETH capabilities for sband/vif
7221  * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
7222  * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
7223  *
7224  * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap, or %NULL is none found
7225  */
7226 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap *
ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_vif * vif)7227 ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7228 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7229 {
7230 	return ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
7231 }
7232 
7233 /**
7234  * ieee80211_update_mu_groups - set the VHT MU-MIMO groud data
7235  *
7236  * @vif: the specified virtual interface
7237  * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, otherwise 0
7238  * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
7239  * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
7240  *
7241  * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid and the position and
7242  * membership data is of the correct size and are in the same byte order as the
7243  * matching GroupId management frame.
7244  * Calls to this function need to be serialized with RX path.
7245  */
7246 void ieee80211_update_mu_groups(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
7247 				const u8 *membership, const u8 *position);
7248 
7249 void ieee80211_enable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7250 				   int rssi_min_thold,
7251 				   int rssi_max_thold);
7252 
7253 void ieee80211_disable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7254 
7255 /**
7256  * ieee80211_ave_rssi - report the average RSSI for the specified interface
7257  *
7258  * @vif: the specified virtual interface
7259  * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, or -1 for non-MLO
7260  *
7261  * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid.
7262  *
7263  * Return: The average RSSI value for the requested interface, or 0 if not
7264  * applicable.
7265  */
7266 int ieee80211_ave_rssi(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int link_id);
7267 
7268 /**
7269  * ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report WoWLAN wakeup
7270  * @vif: virtual interface
7271  * @wakeup: wakeup reason(s)
7272  * @gfp: allocation flags
7273  *
7274  * See cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup().
7275  */
7276 void ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7277 				    struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
7278 				    gfp_t gfp);
7279 
7280 /**
7281  * ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb - prepare an 802.11 skb for transmission
7282  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7283  * @vif: virtual interface
7284  * @skb: frame to be sent from within the driver
7285  * @band: the band to transmit on
7286  * @sta: optional pointer to get the station to send the frame to
7287  *
7288  * Return: %true if the skb was prepared, %false otherwise
7289  *
7290  * Note: must be called under RCU lock
7291  */
7292 bool ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7293 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct sk_buff *skb,
7294 			      int band, struct ieee80211_sta **sta);
7295 
7296 /**
7297  * ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap - Sanity-check and parse the radiotap header
7298  *				 of injected frames.
7299  *
7300  * To accurately parse and take into account rate and retransmission fields,
7301  * you must initialize the chandef field in the ieee80211_tx_info structure
7302  * of the skb before calling this function.
7303  *
7304  * @skb: packet injected by userspace
7305  * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
7306  *
7307  * Return: %true if the radiotap header was parsed, %false otherwise
7308  */
7309 bool ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap(struct sk_buff *skb,
7310 				 struct net_device *dev);
7311 
7312 /**
7313  * struct ieee80211_noa_data - holds temporary data for tracking P2P NoA state
7314  *
7315  * @next_tsf: TSF timestamp of the next absent state change
7316  * @has_next_tsf: next absent state change event pending
7317  *
7318  * @absent: descriptor bitmask, set if GO is currently absent
7319  *
7320  * private:
7321  *
7322  * @count: count fields from the NoA descriptors
7323  * @desc: adjusted data from the NoA
7324  */
7325 struct ieee80211_noa_data {
7326 	u32 next_tsf;
7327 	bool has_next_tsf;
7328 
7329 	u8 absent;
7330 
7331 	u8 count[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
7332 	struct {
7333 		u32 start;
7334 		u32 duration;
7335 		u32 interval;
7336 	} desc[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
7337 };
7338 
7339 /**
7340  * ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa - initialize NoA tracking data from P2P IE
7341  *
7342  * @attr: P2P NoA IE
7343  * @data: NoA tracking data
7344  * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
7345  *
7346  * Return: number of successfully parsed descriptors
7347  */
7348 int ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa(const struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr *attr,
7349 			    struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
7350 
7351 /**
7352  * ieee80211_update_p2p_noa - get next pending P2P GO absent state change
7353  *
7354  * @data: NoA tracking data
7355  * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
7356  */
7357 void ieee80211_update_p2p_noa(struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
7358 
7359 /**
7360  * ieee80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform a TDLS operation
7361  * @vif: virtual interface
7362  * @peer: the peer's destination address
7363  * @oper: the requested TDLS operation
7364  * @reason_code: reason code for the operation, valid for TDLS teardown
7365  * @gfp: allocation flags
7366  *
7367  * See cfg80211_tdls_oper_request().
7368  */
7369 void ieee80211_tdls_oper_request(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *peer,
7370 				 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
7371 				 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
7372 
7373 /**
7374  * ieee80211_reserve_tid - request to reserve a specific TID
7375  *
7376  * There is sometimes a need (such as in TDLS) for blocking the driver from
7377  * using a specific TID so that the FW can use it for certain operations such
7378  * as sending PTI requests. To make sure that the driver doesn't use that TID,
7379  * this function must be called as it flushes out packets on this TID and marks
7380  * it as blocked, so that any transmit for the station on this TID will be
7381  * redirected to the alternative TID in the same AC.
7382  *
7383  * Note that this function blocks and may call back into the driver, so it
7384  * should be called without driver locks held. Also note this function should
7385  * only be called from the driver's @sta_state callback.
7386  *
7387  * @sta: the station to reserve the TID for
7388  * @tid: the TID to reserve
7389  *
7390  * Returns: 0 on success, else on failure
7391  */
7392 int ieee80211_reserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
7393 
7394 /**
7395  * ieee80211_unreserve_tid - request to unreserve a specific TID
7396  *
7397  * Once there is no longer any need for reserving a certain TID, this function
7398  * should be called, and no longer will packets have their TID modified for
7399  * preventing use of this TID in the driver.
7400  *
7401  * Note that this function blocks and acquires a lock, so it should be called
7402  * without driver locks held. Also note this function should only be called
7403  * from the driver's @sta_state callback.
7404  *
7405  * @sta: the station
7406  * @tid: the TID to unreserve
7407  */
7408 void ieee80211_unreserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
7409 
7410 /**
7411  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
7412  *
7413  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7414  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
7415  *	ieee80211_next_txq()
7416  *
7417  * Return: the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available.
7418  *
7419  * Note that this must be called in an rcu_read_lock() critical section,
7420  * which can only be released after the SKB was handled. Some pointers in
7421  * skb->cb, e.g. the key pointer, are protected by RCU and thus the
7422  * critical section must persist not just for the duration of this call
7423  * but for the duration of the frame handling.
7424  * However, also note that while in the wake_tx_queue() method,
7425  * rcu_read_lock() is already held.
7426  *
7427  * softirqs must also be disabled when this function is called.
7428  * In process context, use ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni() instead.
7429  */
7430 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7431 				     struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7432 
7433 /**
7434  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
7435  * (in process context)
7436  *
7437  * Like ieee80211_tx_dequeue() but can be called in process context
7438  * (internally disables bottom halves).
7439  *
7440  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7441  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
7442  *	ieee80211_next_txq()
7443  *
7444  * Return: the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available.
7445  */
ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_txq * txq)7446 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7447 						      struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
7448 {
7449 	struct sk_buff *skb;
7450 
7451 	local_bh_disable();
7452 	skb = ieee80211_tx_dequeue(hw, txq);
7453 	local_bh_enable();
7454 
7455 	return skb;
7456 }
7457 
7458 /**
7459  * ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue - mac80211 handler for wake_tx_queue callback
7460  *
7461  * @hw: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
7462  * @txq: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
7463  *
7464  * Drivers can use this function for the mandatory mac80211 wake_tx_queue
7465  * callback in struct ieee80211_ops. They should not call this function.
7466  */
7467 void ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7468 				    struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7469 
7470 /**
7471  * ieee80211_next_txq - get next tx queue to pull packets from
7472  *
7473  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7474  * @ac: AC number to return packets from.
7475  *
7476  * Return: the next txq if successful, %NULL if no queue is eligible. If a txq
7477  * is returned, it should be returned with ieee80211_return_txq() after the
7478  * driver has finished scheduling it.
7479  */
7480 struct ieee80211_txq *ieee80211_next_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7481 
7482 /**
7483  * ieee80211_txq_schedule_start - start new scheduling round for TXQs
7484  *
7485  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7486  * @ac: AC number to acquire locks for
7487  *
7488  * Should be called before ieee80211_next_txq() or ieee80211_return_txq().
7489  * The driver must not call multiple TXQ scheduling rounds concurrently.
7490  */
7491 void ieee80211_txq_schedule_start(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7492 
7493 /* (deprecated) */
ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,u8 ac)7494 static inline void ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac)
7495 {
7496 }
7497 
7498 void __ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7499 			      struct ieee80211_txq *txq, bool force);
7500 
7501 /**
7502  * ieee80211_schedule_txq - schedule a TXQ for transmission
7503  *
7504  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7505  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7506  *
7507  * Schedules a TXQ for transmission if it is not already scheduled,
7508  * even if mac80211 does not have any packets buffered.
7509  *
7510  * The driver may call this function if it has buffered packets for
7511  * this TXQ internally.
7512  */
7513 static inline void
ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_txq * txq)7514 ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
7515 {
7516 	__ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, true);
7517 }
7518 
7519 /**
7520  * ieee80211_return_txq - return a TXQ previously acquired by ieee80211_next_txq()
7521  *
7522  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7523  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7524  * @force: schedule txq even if mac80211 does not have any buffered packets.
7525  *
7526  * The driver may set force=true if it has buffered packets for this TXQ
7527  * internally.
7528  */
7529 static inline void
ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_txq * txq,bool force)7530 ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7531 		     bool force)
7532 {
7533 	__ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, force);
7534 }
7535 
7536 /**
7537  * ieee80211_txq_may_transmit - check whether TXQ is allowed to transmit
7538  *
7539  * This function is used to check whether given txq is allowed to transmit by
7540  * the airtime scheduler, and can be used by drivers to access the airtime
7541  * fairness accounting without using the scheduling order enforced by
7542  * next_txq().
7543  *
7544  * Returns %true if the airtime scheduler thinks the TXQ should be allowed to
7545  * transmit, and %false if it should be throttled. This function can also have
7546  * the side effect of rotating the TXQ in the scheduler rotation, which will
7547  * eventually bring the deficit to positive and allow the station to transmit
7548  * again.
7549  *
7550  * The API ieee80211_txq_may_transmit() also ensures that TXQ list will be
7551  * aligned against driver's own round-robin scheduler list. i.e it rotates
7552  * the TXQ list till it makes the requested node becomes the first entry
7553  * in TXQ list. Thus both the TXQ list and driver's list are in sync. If this
7554  * function returns %true, the driver is expected to schedule packets
7555  * for transmission, and then return the TXQ through ieee80211_return_txq().
7556  *
7557  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7558  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7559  *
7560  * Return: %true if transmission is allowed, %false otherwise
7561  */
7562 bool ieee80211_txq_may_transmit(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7563 				struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7564 
7565 /**
7566  * ieee80211_txq_get_depth - get pending frame/byte count of given txq
7567  *
7568  * The values are not guaranteed to be coherent with regard to each other, i.e.
7569  * txq state can change half-way of this function and the caller may end up
7570  * with "new" frame_cnt and "old" byte_cnt or vice-versa.
7571  *
7572  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7573  * @frame_cnt: pointer to store frame count
7574  * @byte_cnt: pointer to store byte count
7575  */
7576 void ieee80211_txq_get_depth(struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7577 			     unsigned long *frame_cnt,
7578 			     unsigned long *byte_cnt);
7579 
7580 /**
7581  * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
7582  *
7583  * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function termination.
7584  * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7585  *
7586  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7587  * @inst_id: the local instance id
7588  * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
7589  * @gfp: allocation flags
7590  */
7591 void ieee80211_nan_func_terminated(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7592 				   u8 inst_id,
7593 				   enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
7594 				   gfp_t gfp);
7595 
7596 /**
7597  * ieee80211_nan_func_match - notify about NAN function match event.
7598  *
7599  * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function match. The
7600  * cookie inside the match struct will be assigned by mac80211.
7601  * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7602  *
7603  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7604  * @match: match event information
7605  * @gfp: allocation flags
7606  */
7607 void ieee80211_nan_func_match(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7608 			      struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match,
7609 			      gfp_t gfp);
7610 
7611 /**
7612  * ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for RX.
7613  *
7614  * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7615  * rate information in the RX status struct and the frame length.
7616  *
7617  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7618  * @status: &struct ieee80211_rx_status containing the transmission rate
7619  *          information.
7620  * @len: frame length in bytes
7621  *
7622  * Return: the airtime estimate
7623  */
7624 u32 ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7625 			      struct ieee80211_rx_status *status,
7626 			      int len);
7627 
7628 /**
7629  * ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for TX.
7630  *
7631  * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7632  * rate information in the TX info struct and the frame length.
7633  *
7634  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7635  * @info: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
7636  * @len: frame length in bytes
7637  *
7638  * Return: the airtime estimate
7639  */
7640 u32 ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7641 			      struct ieee80211_tx_info *info,
7642 			      int len);
7643 /**
7644  * ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl - Get FILS discovery template.
7645  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7646  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7647  *
7648  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7649  *
7650  * Return: FILS discovery template. %NULL on error.
7651  */
7652 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7653 						  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7654 
7655 /**
7656  * ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl - Get unsolicited broadcast
7657  *	probe response template.
7658  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7659  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7660  *
7661  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7662  *
7663  * Return: Unsolicited broadcast probe response template. %NULL on error.
7664  */
7665 struct sk_buff *
7666 ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7667 					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7668 
7669 /**
7670  * ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify userland about a BSS color
7671  * collision.
7672  * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
7673  *
7674  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7675  * @color_bitmap: a 64 bit bitmap representing the colors that the local BSS is
7676  *	aware of.
7677  */
7678 void
7679 ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7680 				      u64 color_bitmap, u8 link_id);
7681 
7682 /**
7683  * ieee80211_is_tx_data - check if frame is a data frame
7684  *
7685  * The function is used to check if a frame is a data frame. Frames with
7686  * hardware encapsulation enabled are data frames.
7687  *
7688  * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
7689  *
7690  * Return: %true if @skb is a data frame, %false otherwise
7691  */
ieee80211_is_tx_data(struct sk_buff * skb)7692 static inline bool ieee80211_is_tx_data(struct sk_buff *skb)
7693 {
7694 	struct ieee80211_tx_info *info = IEEE80211_SKB_CB(skb);
7695 	struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (void *) skb->data;
7696 
7697 	return info->flags & IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP ||
7698 	       ieee80211_is_data(hdr->frame_control);
7699 }
7700 
7701 /**
7702  * ieee80211_set_active_links - set active links in client mode
7703  * @vif: interface to set active links on
7704  * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7705  *
7706  * Context: Must be called with wiphy mutex held; may sleep; calls
7707  *	back into the driver.
7708  *
7709  * This changes the active links on an interface. The interface
7710  * must be in client mode (in AP mode, all links are always active),
7711  * and @active_links must be a subset of the vif's valid_links.
7712  *
7713  * If a link is switched off and another is switched on at the same
7714  * time (e.g. active_links going from 0x1 to 0x10) then you will get
7715  * a sequence of calls like
7716  *
7717  *  - change_vif_links(0x11)
7718  *  - unassign_vif_chanctx(link_id=0)
7719  *  - assign_vif_chanctx(link_id=4)
7720  *  - change_sta_links(0x11) for each affected STA (the AP)
7721  *    (TDLS connections on now inactive links should be torn down)
7722  *  - remove group keys on the old link (link_id 0)
7723  *  - add new group keys (GTK/IGTK/BIGTK) on the new link (link_id 4)
7724  *  - change_sta_links(0x10) for each affected STA (the AP)
7725  *  - change_vif_links(0x10)
7726  *
7727  * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
7728  */
7729 int ieee80211_set_active_links(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 active_links);
7730 
7731 /**
7732  * ieee80211_set_active_links_async - asynchronously set active links
7733  * @vif: interface to set active links on
7734  * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7735  *
7736  * See ieee80211_set_active_links() for more information, the only
7737  * difference here is that the link change is triggered async and
7738  * can be called in any context, but the link switch will only be
7739  * completed after it returns.
7740  */
7741 void ieee80211_set_active_links_async(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7742 				      u16 active_links);
7743 
7744 /**
7745  * ieee80211_send_teardown_neg_ttlm - tear down a negotiated TTLM request
7746  * @vif: the interface on which the tear down request should be sent.
7747  *
7748  * This function can be used to tear down a previously accepted negotiated
7749  * TTLM request.
7750  */
7751 void ieee80211_send_teardown_neg_ttlm(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7752 
7753 /**
7754  * ieee80211_chan_width_to_rx_bw - convert channel width to STA RX bandwidth
7755  * @width: the channel width value to convert
7756  * Return: the STA RX bandwidth value for the channel width
7757  */
7758 static inline enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth
ieee80211_chan_width_to_rx_bw(enum nl80211_chan_width width)7759 ieee80211_chan_width_to_rx_bw(enum nl80211_chan_width width)
7760 {
7761 	switch (width) {
7762 	default:
7763 		WARN_ON_ONCE(1);
7764 		fallthrough;
7765 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT:
7766 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20:
7767 		return IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20;
7768 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40:
7769 		return IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40;
7770 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80:
7771 		return IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80;
7772 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_160:
7773 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80P80:
7774 		return IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160;
7775 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_320:
7776 		return IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320;
7777 	}
7778 }
7779 
7780 /**
7781  * ieee80211_prepare_rx_omi_bw - prepare for sending BW RX OMI
7782  * @link_sta: the link STA the OMI is going to be sent to
7783  * @bw: the bandwidth requested
7784  *
7785  * When the driver decides to do RX OMI to change bandwidth with a STA
7786  * it calls this function to prepare, then sends the OMI, and finally
7787  * calls ieee80211_finalize_rx_omi_bw().
7788  *
7789  * Note that the (link) STA rate control is updated accordingly as well,
7790  * but the chanctx might not be updated if there are other users.
7791  * If the intention is to reduce the listen bandwidth, the driver must
7792  * ensure there are no TDLS stations nor other uses of the chanctx.
7793  *
7794  * Also note that in order to sequence correctly, narrowing bandwidth
7795  * will only happen in ieee80211_finalize_rx_omi_bw(), whereas widening
7796  * again (e.g. going back to normal) will happen here.
7797  *
7798  * Note that we treat this symmetrically, so if the driver calls this
7799  * and tells the peer to only send with a lower bandwidth, we assume
7800  * that the driver also wants to only send at that lower bandwidth, to
7801  * allow narrowing of the chanctx request for this station/interface.
7802  *
7803  * Finally, the driver must ensure that if the function returned %true,
7804  * ieee80211_finalize_rx_omi_bw() is also called, even for example in
7805  * case of HW restart.
7806  *
7807  * Context: Must be called with wiphy mutex held, and will call back
7808  *	    into the driver, so ensure no driver locks are held.
7809  *
7810  * Return: %true if changes are going to be made, %false otherwise
7811  */
7812 bool ieee80211_prepare_rx_omi_bw(struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
7813 				 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth bw);
7814 
7815 /**
7816  * ieee80211_finalize_rx_omi_bw - finalize BW RX OMI update
7817  * @link_sta: the link STA the OMI was sent to
7818  *
7819  * See ieee80211_client_prepare_rx_omi_bw(). Context is the same here
7820  * as well.
7821  */
7822 void ieee80211_finalize_rx_omi_bw(struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta);
7823 
7824 /* for older drivers - let's not document these ... */
7825 int ieee80211_emulate_add_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7826 				  struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
7827 void ieee80211_emulate_remove_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7828 				      struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
7829 void ieee80211_emulate_change_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7830 				      struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx,
7831 				      u32 changed);
7832 int ieee80211_emulate_switch_vif_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7833 					 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs,
7834 					 int n_vifs,
7835 					 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode);
7836 
7837 #endif /* MAC80211_H */
7838